blob: 674134e10f06c5e7f8731026c19743bd2f63308e [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreaufba74ea2018-12-22 11:19:45 +01005 version 2.0
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau6e893b92019-03-26 05:40:51 +01007 2019/03/26
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020054
554. Proxies
564.1. Proxy keywords matrix
574.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
58
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100595. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200605.1. Bind options
615.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200625.3. Server DNS resolution
635.3.1. Global overview
645.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020065
666. HTTP header manipulation
67
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200687. Using ACLs and fetching samples
697.1. ACL basics
707.1.1. Matching booleans
717.1.2. Matching integers
727.1.3. Matching strings
737.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
747.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
757.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
767.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
777.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200787.3.1. Converters
797.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
807.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
817.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
827.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
837.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200847.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085
868. Logging
878.1. Log levels
888.2. Log formats
898.2.1. Default log format
908.2.2. TCP log format
918.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100928.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100938.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200948.3. Advanced logging options
958.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
968.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
978.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
988.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
998.4. Timing events
1008.5. Session state at disconnection
1018.6. Non-printable characters
1028.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1038.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1048.9. Examples of logs
105
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001069. Supported filters
1079.1. Trace
1089.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001099.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001109.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200111
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010011210. Cache
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010011310.1. Limitation
11410.2. Setup
11510.2.1. Cache section
11610.2.2. Proxy section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117
1181. Quick reminder about HTTP
119----------------------------
120
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100121When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
123on almost anything found in the contents.
124
125However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
126formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
127correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
128
129
1301.1. The HTTP transaction model
131-------------------------------
132
133The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100134to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100135from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
136connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200137will involve a new connection :
138
139 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
140
141In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
142establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
143by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
144length.
145
146Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
147to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
148however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
149response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
150header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
151
152 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
153
154Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
155power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
156but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200157a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100159Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200160keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
161second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
162page :
163
164 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
165
166This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
167latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
168correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
169the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100170server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100172The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
173time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
174are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
175parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
176carry the stream identifier.
177
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100178By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
179connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
180leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100181start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
182processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
183waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200184
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200185HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100186 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
187 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100188 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100189 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200190 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100191
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100192For HTTP/2, the connection mode resembles more the "server close" mode : given
193the independence of all streams, there is currently no place to hook the idle
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100194server connection after a response, so it is closed after the response. HTTP/2
195is only supported for incoming connections, not on connections going to
196servers.
197
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200198
1991.2. HTTP request
200-----------------
201
202First, let's consider this HTTP request :
203
204 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100205 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
207 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
208 3 User-agent: my small browser
209 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
210 5 Accept: image/png
211
212
2131.2.1. The Request line
214-----------------------
215
216Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
217
218 - a METHOD : GET
219 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
220 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
221
222All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
223which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
224followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
225is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
226desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
227the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
228
229The URI itself can have several forms :
230
231 - A "relative URI" :
232
233 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
234
235 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
236 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
237
238 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
239
240 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
241
242 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
243 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
244 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
245 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
246 must accept this form too.
247
248 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
249 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
250 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100251
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200252 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
253 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
254 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
255 other protocols too.
256
257In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
258mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
259on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
260It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
261specific to the language, framework or application in use.
262
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100263HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100264assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100265However, haproxy natively processes HTTP/1.x requests and headers, so requests
266received over an HTTP/2 connection are transcoded to HTTP/1.1 before being
267processed. This explains why they still appear as "HTTP/1.1" in haproxy's logs
268as well as in server logs.
269
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200270
2711.2.2. The request headers
272--------------------------
273
274The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
275beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
276an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
277Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
278values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
279encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
280the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
281define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
282
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100283Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200284their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100285"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
286as can be seen when running in debug mode.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200287
288The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
289that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
290is one valid form of empty line.
291
292Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
293headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
294about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
295application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
296
297Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000298 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200299 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
300 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
301 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
302
303
3041.3. HTTP response
305------------------
306
307An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
308messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
309
310 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100311 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200312 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
313 2 Content-length: 350
314 3 Content-Type: text/html
315
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200316As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
317codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
318response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100319continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
320the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
321following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
322sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
323(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
324correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
325such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
326state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
327over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
328if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
329information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200330
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200331
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003321.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200333------------------------
334
335Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
336
337 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
338 - a status code : 200
339 - a reason : OK
340
341The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100342 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
343 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
344 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
345 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
346 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200347
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000348Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100349"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200350found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
351messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
352or "Authentication Required".
353
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100354HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200355
356 Code When / reason
357 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
358 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
359 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
360 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100361 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
362 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200363 400 for an invalid or too large request
364 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
365 accessing the stats page)
366 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
367 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
368 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
369 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
370 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
371 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
372 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
373 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
374 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
375
376The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3774.2).
378
379
3801.3.2. The response headers
381---------------------------
382
383Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
384the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
385details.
386
387
3882. Configuring HAProxy
389----------------------
390
3912.1. Configuration file format
392------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200393
394HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
395
396 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
397 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
398 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
399 "frontend" and "backend".
400
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100401The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
402referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200403delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100404
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200405
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004062.2. Quoting and escaping
407-------------------------
408
409HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
410many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
411with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
412single quotes.
413
414If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
415them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
416escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
417
418Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
419
420 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
421 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
422 \\ to use a backslash
423 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
424 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
425
426Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
427the interpretation of:
428
429 space as a parameter separator
430 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
431 # hash as a comment start
432
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200433Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
434-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
435backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
436
437Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200438quoting.
439
440Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
441nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
442
443Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
444equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
445
446 Example:
447 # those are equivalents:
448 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
449 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
450 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
451 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
452 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
453
454 # those are equivalents:
455 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
456 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
457 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
458 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
459
460
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004612.3. Environment variables
462--------------------------
463
464HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
465interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
466configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
467optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
468shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
469underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
470
471 Example:
472
473 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
474
475 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
476
477 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
478
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200479A special variable $HAPROXY_LOCALPEER is defined at the startup of the process
480which contains the name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
481
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200482
4832.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200484----------------
485
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100486Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100487values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
488otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
489numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
490for every keyword. Supported units are :
491
492 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
493 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
494 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
495 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
496 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
497 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
498
499
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005002.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200501-------------
502
503 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
504 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
505 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
506 global
507 daemon
508 maxconn 256
509
510 defaults
511 mode http
512 timeout connect 5000ms
513 timeout client 50000ms
514 timeout server 50000ms
515
516 frontend http-in
517 bind *:80
518 default_backend servers
519
520 backend servers
521 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
522
523
524 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
525 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
526 global
527 daemon
528 maxconn 256
529
530 defaults
531 mode http
532 timeout connect 5000ms
533 timeout client 50000ms
534 timeout server 50000ms
535
536 listen http-in
537 bind *:80
538 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
539
540
541Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
542
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100543 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200544
545
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005463. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200547--------------------
548
549Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
550are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
551of them have command-line equivalents.
552
553The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
554
555 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200556 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200557 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200558 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200559 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200560 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200561 - description
562 - deviceatlas-json-file
563 - deviceatlas-log-level
564 - deviceatlas-separator
565 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900566 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200567 - gid
568 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100569 - hard-stop-after
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200570 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200571 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100572 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200573 - lua-load
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200574 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200575 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200576 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200577 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100578 - presetenv
579 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200580 - uid
581 - ulimit-n
582 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200583 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100584 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200585 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200586 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200587 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200588 - ssl-default-bind-options
589 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200590 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200591 - ssl-default-server-options
592 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100593 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100594 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100595 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100596 - 51degrees-data-file
597 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200598 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200599 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200600 - wurfl-data-file
601 - wurfl-information-list
602 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200603 - wurfl-cache-size
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100604
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200605 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200606 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200607 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200608 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100609 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100610 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100611 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200612 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200613 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200614 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200615 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200616 - noepoll
617 - nokqueue
618 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100619 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300620 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000621 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100622 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200623 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200624 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200625 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000626 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000627 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200628 - tune.buffers.limit
629 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200630 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200631 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100632 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200633 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200634 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200635 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100636 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200637 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200638 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100639 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100640 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100641 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100642 - tune.lua.session-timeout
643 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200644 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100645 - tune.maxaccept
646 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200647 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200648 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200649 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100650 - tune.rcvbuf.client
651 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100652 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200653 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100654 - tune.sndbuf.client
655 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100656 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100657 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200658 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100659 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200660 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200661 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100662 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200663 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100664 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200665 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
666 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
667 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100668 - tune.zlib.memlevel
669 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100670
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200671 * Debugging
672 - debug
673 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200674
675
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006763.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200677------------------------------------
678
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200679ca-base <dir>
680 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200681 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
682 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200683
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200684chroot <jail dir>
685 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
686 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
687 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
688 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
689 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100690 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100691
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100692cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
693 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
694 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
695 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
696 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
697 set. These sets have the format
698
699 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
700
701 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100702 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100703 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
704 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100705 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
706 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100707 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100708 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100709 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100710 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100711 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
712 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
713 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
714 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100715
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100716 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
717 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
718 on the machine's word size.
719
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100720 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100721 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
722 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
723 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
724 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
725 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
726 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100727
728 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100729 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
730
731 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
732 # first 4 CPUs
733
734 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
735 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
736 # word size.
737
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100738 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100739 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100740 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
741 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
742 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
743
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100744 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
745 # and so on.
746 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
747 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
748 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
749
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100750 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100751 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
752 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
753 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
754
755 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
756 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
757 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
758
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100759 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
760 # and a thread range.
761 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
762 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
763 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
764
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200765crt-base <dir>
766 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
767 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
768 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
769
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200770daemon
771 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
772 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100773 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
774 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200775
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200776deviceatlas-json-file <path>
777 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100778 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200779
780deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100781 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200782 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
783
784deviceatlas-separator <char>
785 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
786 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
787
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100788deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200789 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
790 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
791 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100792
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900793external-check
794 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
795 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
796 See "option external-check".
797
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200798gid <number>
799 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
800 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
801 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100802 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
803 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200804 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100805
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100806hard-stop-after <time>
807 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
808
809 Arguments :
810 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
811 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
812 SIGUSR1 signal.
813
814 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
815 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
816 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
817
818 Example:
819 global
820 hard-stop-after 30s
821
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200822group <group name>
823 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
824 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100825
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200826log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
827 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100828 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100829 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100830 configured with "log global".
831
832 <address> can be one of:
833
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100834 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100835 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
836 port).
837
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100838 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
839 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
840 port).
841
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100842 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100843 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
844 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100845 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100846
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100847 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
848 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
849 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
850 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
851 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
852 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
853 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
854 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
855 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
856 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
857 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
858 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
859 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
860 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100861 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
862 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100863
864 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
865 "fd@2", see above.
866
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200867 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
868 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100869
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200870 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
871 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
872 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
873 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
874 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
875 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
876 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
877 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
878 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
879 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100880 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
881 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200882
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200883 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
884 one of the following :
885
886 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
887 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
888
889 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
890 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
891
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100892 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
893 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
894 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
895 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
896 logger consumes.
897
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100898 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
899 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
900 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
901 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
902
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200903 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
904 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
905 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
906 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
907 set with <sample_size> parameter.
908
909 <sample_size>
910 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
911 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
912 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
913 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
914 (see also <ranges> parameter).
915
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100916 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200917
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100918 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
919 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
920 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
921
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100922 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
923 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
924 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
925 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200926
927 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200928 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
929 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
930 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
931 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
932 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
933 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200934
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200935 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200936
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100937log-send-hostname [<string>]
938 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
939 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
940 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
941 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
942 the logs.
943
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000944log-tag <string>
945 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
946 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
947 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100948 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000949
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100950lua-load <file>
951 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
952 used multiple times.
953
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100954master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200955 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
956 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
957 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100958 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200959 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
960 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100961 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
962 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
963 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
964 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
965 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200966
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100967 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200968
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200969nbproc <number>
970 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
971 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
972 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +0100973 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
974 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +0100975 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon" and
976 "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200977
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200978nbthread <number>
979 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +0100980 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
981 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
982 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
983 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
984 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +0100985 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
986 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
987 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
988 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
989 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
990 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
991 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200992
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200993pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100994 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200995 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
996 starting the process. See also "daemon".
997
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100998presetenv <name> <value>
999 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1000 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1001 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1002 and "unsetenv".
1003
1004resetenv [<name> ...]
1005 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1006 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1007 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1008 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1009 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1010 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1011 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1012 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1013
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001014stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001015 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1016 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1017 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1018 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1019 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1020 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001021 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001022 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1023 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1024 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1025 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001026
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001027server-state-base <directory>
1028 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001029 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1030 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001031
1032server-state-file <file>
1033 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1034 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1035 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1036 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1037 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1038 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1039 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1040 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001041 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1042 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001043
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001044setenv <name> <value>
1045 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1046 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1047 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1048 and "unsetenv".
1049
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001050set-dumpable
1051 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
1052 developer's request. It has no impact on performance nor stability but will
1053 try hard to re-enable core dumps that were possibly disabled by file size
1054 limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations (ulimit -c), or "dumpability"
1055 of a process after changing its UID/GID (such as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable
1056 on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by the current directory's
1057 permissions (check what directory the file is started from), the chroot
1058 directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily disable the chroot
1059 directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location), or any other
1060 system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are notorious
1061 for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable not even
1062 installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often, simply
1063 writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the issue.
1064 When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to re-appear, it's
1065 often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by issuing, for example,
1066 "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it leaves a core where
1067 expected when dying.
1068
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001069ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1070 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1071 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001072 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001073 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001074 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1075 information and recommendations see e.g.
1076 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1077 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1078 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1079 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001080
1081ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1082 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1083 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1084 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1085 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1086 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001087 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1088 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1089 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001090 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001091
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001092ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1093 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1094 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1095 keyword to see available options.
1096
1097 Example:
1098 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001099 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001100
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001101ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1102 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1103 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001104 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001105 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001106 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1107 information and recommendations see e.g.
1108 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1109 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1110 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1111 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1112 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001113
1114ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1115 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1116 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1117 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1118 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1119 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001120 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1121 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1122 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1123 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001124
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001125ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1126 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1127 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1128 keyword to see available options.
1129
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001130ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1131 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1132 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1133 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001134 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001135 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001136 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1137 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1138 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1139 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001140 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1141 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1142 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1143
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001144ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1145 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1146 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1147 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1148
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001149stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1150 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1151 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1152 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001153 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001154 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001155
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001156 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1157 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1158 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001159
1160stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1161 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1162 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001163 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001164
1165stats maxconn <connections>
1166 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1167 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1168
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001169uid <number>
1170 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1171 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1172 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1173 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1174
1175ulimit-n <number>
1176 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1177 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1178 option.
1179
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001180unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1181 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1182
1183 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1184 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1185 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1186 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1187 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1188 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1189 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1190 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1191 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1192 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1193
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001194unsetenv [<name> ...]
1195 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1196 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1197 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1198 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1199 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1200 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1201 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1202
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001203user <user name>
1204 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1205 See also "uid" and "group".
1206
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001207node <name>
1208 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1209
1210 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1211 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1212 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1213 traffic.
1214
1215description <text>
1216 Add a text that describes the instance.
1217
1218 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1219 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1220 "<" and ">" characters.
1221
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100122251degrees-data-file <file path>
1223 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001224 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001225
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001226 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001227 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1228
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000122951degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001230 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1231 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1232 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1233
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001234 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001235 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1236
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200123751degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001238 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1239 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1240
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001241 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1242 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1243
124451degrees-cache-size <number>
1245 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1246 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1247 By default, this cache is disabled.
1248
1249 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001250 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1251
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001252wurfl-data-file <file path>
1253 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1254 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1255
1256 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1257 with USE_WURFL=1.
1258
1259wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1260 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1261 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1262 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1263
1264 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1265
1266 Valid WURFL properties are:
1267 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1268
1269 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1270 device.
1271
1272 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1273 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1274
1275 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1276 particular web request.
1277
1278 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1279 used Libwurfl API version.
1280
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001281 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1282 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1283
1284 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1285 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1286
1287 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1288
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001289 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1290 with USE_WURFL=1.
1291
1292wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1293 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1294 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1295
1296 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1297 with USE_WURFL=1.
1298
1299wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1300 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1301 thus before the chroot.
1302
1303 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1304 with USE_WURFL=1.
1305
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001306wurfl-cache-size <size>
1307 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1308 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001309 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001310 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001311
1312 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1313 with USE_WURFL=1.
1314
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013153.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001316-----------------------
1317
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001318busy-polling
1319 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1320 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1321 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1322 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1323 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1324 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1325 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1326 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1327 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1328 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1329 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1330 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1331 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1332 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1333 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1334 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1335 "poll" pollers.
1336
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001337max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1338 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1339 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1340 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1341 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1342 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1343 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1344 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1345 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1346
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001347maxconn <number>
1348 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1349 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1350 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001351 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1352 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1353 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1354 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001355 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1356 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1357 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1358 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1359 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1360 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001361
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001362maxconnrate <number>
1363 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1364 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1365 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1366 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1367 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1368 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1369 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1370 fairness.
1371
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001372maxcomprate <number>
1373 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001374 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001375 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1376 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1377 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001378 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001379 default value.
1380
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001381maxcompcpuusage <number>
1382 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1383 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1384 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1385 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1386 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1387 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1388 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1389 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1390
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001391maxpipes <number>
1392 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1393 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1394 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1395 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1396 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1397 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1398
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001399maxsessrate <number>
1400 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1401 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1402 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1403 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1404 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1405 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1406 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1407 fairness.
1408
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001409maxsslconn <number>
1410 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1411 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1412 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1413 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1414 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1415 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1416 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001417 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1418 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1419 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1420 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1421 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1422 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1423 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001424
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001425maxsslrate <number>
1426 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1427 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1428 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1429 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1430 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1431 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1432 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1433 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1434 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1435 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1436
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001437maxzlibmem <number>
1438 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1439 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1440 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001441 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1442 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1443 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1444
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001445noepoll
1446 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1447 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001448 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001449
1450nokqueue
1451 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1452 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1453 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1454
1455nopoll
1456 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1457 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001458 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001459 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001460
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001461nosplice
1462 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001463 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001464 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001465 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001466 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1467 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1468 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1469 "option splice-response".
1470
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001471nogetaddrinfo
1472 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1473 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1474
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001475noreuseport
1476 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1477 command line argument "-dR".
1478
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001479profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
1480 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
1481 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
1482 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
1483 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
1484 reutnrs below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
1485 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
1486 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
1487 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
1488 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
1489
1490 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
1491 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
1492 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
1493 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
1494 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001495 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1496 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1497 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1498 CLI.
1499
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001500spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001501 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1502 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1503 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1504 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1505 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1506 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001507
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001508ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001509 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001510 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001511 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1512 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1513 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1514 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1515 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001516 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1517 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001518 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1519 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1520 openssl configuration file uses:
1521 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1522
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001523ssl-mode-async
1524 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001525 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001526 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1527 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1528 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
1529 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and reneg
1530 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001531
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001532tune.buffers.limit <number>
1533 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1534 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1535 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1536 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1537 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001538 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001539 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1540 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1541 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1542 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1543 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1544 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1545 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1546 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1547 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1548
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001549tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1550 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1551 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1552 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1553 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1554
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001555tune.bufsize <number>
1556 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1557 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1558 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1559 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1560 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1561 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1562 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001563 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1564 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1565 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001566 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001567 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1568 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1569 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001570
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001571tune.chksize <number>
1572 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1573 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1574 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1575 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1576 checks whenever possible.
1577
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001578tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1579 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1580 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1581 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1582 this value. The default value is 1.
1583
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01001584tune.fail-alloc
1585 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1586 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1587 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1588 gracefully.
1589
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001590tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1591 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1592 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1593 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1594 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1595 change it.
1596
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001597tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1598 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001599 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1600 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001601 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1602 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1603 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1604 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1605 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1606
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001607tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1608 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1609 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1610 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1611 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1612 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1613 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1614 recommended not to change this value.
1615
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001616tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1617 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1618 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1619 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1620 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1621 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1622 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1623 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1624
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001625tune.http.cookielen <number>
1626 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1627 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1628 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1629 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1630 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1631 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1632 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1633 to change this value.
1634
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001635tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001636 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1637 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001638 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001639 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001640 configuration directives too.
1641 The default value is 1024.
1642
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001643tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1644 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1645 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1646 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1647 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1648 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1649 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001650 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1651 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1652 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001653
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001654tune.idletimer <timeout>
1655 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1656 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1657 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1658 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1659 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1660 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001661 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001662 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
1663 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1664
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01001665tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
1666 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
1667 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
1668 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
1669 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
1670 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
1671 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
1672 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
1673 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
1674 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
1675
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001676tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1677 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001678 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001679 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1680 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001681 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001682 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1683 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1684
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001685tune.lua.maxmem
1686 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1687 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1688 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1689 memory.
1690
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001691tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1692 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001693 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1694 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001695 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001696
1697tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1698 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1699 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1700 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1701 check servers.
1702
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001703tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1704 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1705 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1706 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001707 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001708
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001709tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001710 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1711 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1712 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1713 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1714 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1715 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1716 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1717 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1718 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1719 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001720
1721tune.maxpollevents <number>
1722 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1723 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1724 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1725 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1726 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1727
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001728tune.maxrewrite <number>
1729 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1730 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1731 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1732 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1733 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1734 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1735 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1736 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1737 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1738 bufsize.
1739
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001740tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1741 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1742 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1743 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1744 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1745 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1746 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1747 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1748 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1749 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
1750 about 5 MB on 32-bit systems and 8 MB on 64-bit systems. There is a very low
1751 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1752 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1753 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1754 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1755 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1756 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1757 setting this parameter to 0.
1758
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001759tune.pipesize <number>
1760 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1761 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1762 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1763 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1764 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1765 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1766
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02001767tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
1768 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1769 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1770 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
1771 default is 20.
1772
1773tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
1774 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1775 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1776 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
1777 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
1778 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
1779 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
1780 much sense in the general case when targetting connection reuse).
1781
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001782tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1783tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1784 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1785 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1786 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1787 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001788 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001789 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1790 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1791
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001792tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001793 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001794 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1795 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1796 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1797 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1798
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001799tune.runqueue-depth <number>
1800 Sets the maxinum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
1801 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
1802 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead.
1803
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001804tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1805tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1806 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1807 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1808 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1809 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001810 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001811 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1812 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1813 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1814 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1815 notifying haproxy again.
1816
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001817tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001818 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1819 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1820 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001821 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001822 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001823 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001824 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1825 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1826 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001827 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1828 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001829
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001830tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02001831 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001832 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1833 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1834 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1835 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1836 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1837
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001838tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1839 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001840 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001841 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1842 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1843 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1844 being used for too long.
1845
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001846tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1847 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1848 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1849 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1850 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1851 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1852 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1853 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1854 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1855 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1856 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001857 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001858 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001859
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001860tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1861 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1862 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1863 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1864 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1865 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1866 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1867 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001868 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1869 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001870
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001871tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1872 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1873 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1874 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1875 1000 entries.
1876
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001877tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
1878 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
1879 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
1880 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
1881
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001882tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001883tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001884tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1885tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1886tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001887 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
1888 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
1889 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
1890 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
1891 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
1892 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
1893 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
1894 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001895
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001896 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
1897 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
1898 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1899 all available space is consumed.
1900 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
1901 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
1902 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001903
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001904tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1905 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001906 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001907 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001908 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001909 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1910
1911tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1912 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1913 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001914 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1915 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001916
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019173.3. Debugging
1918--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001919
1920debug
1921 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1922 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1923 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1924 system startup.
1925
1926quiet
1927 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1928 line argument "-q".
1929
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001930
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019313.4. Userlists
1932--------------
1933It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1934http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1935it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1936
1937userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001938 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001939 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1940
1941group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001942 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001943 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1944 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1945
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001946user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1947 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001948 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1949 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01001950 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
1951 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
1952 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
1953 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001954
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01001955 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
1956 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
1957 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
1958 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
1959 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
1960 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
1961 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
1962 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
1963 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001964
1965 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001966 userlist L1
1967 group G1 users tiger,scott
1968 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001969
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001970 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1971 user scott insecure-password elgato
1972 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001973
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001974 userlist L2
1975 group G1
1976 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001977
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001978 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1979 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1980 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001981
1982 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001983
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001984
19853.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001986----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02001987It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
1988several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
1989instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
1990values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
1991automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
1992In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
1993using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
1994tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
1995reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
1996Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
1997that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
1998each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001999
2000peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002001 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002002 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2003
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002004bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2005 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2006 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2007
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002008disabled
2009 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2010 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2011 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2012
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002013default-bind [param*]
2014 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2015
2016default-server [param*]
2017 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2018
2019 Arguments:
2020 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2021 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2022 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2023 details.
2024
2025
2026 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2027
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002028enable
2029 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2030
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002031peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002032 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2033 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
2034 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
2035 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
2036 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
2037 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
2038
2039 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2040 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2041
2042 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
2043 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
2044 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
2045 across all peers.
2046
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002047 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2048 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002049
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002050 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2051 "server" keyword explanation below).
2052
2053server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
2054 As previously mentionned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
2055 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2056 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2057 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2058 of this "peers" section).
2059 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2060
2061
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002062 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002063 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002064 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002065 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2066 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2067 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002068
2069 backend mybackend
2070 mode tcp
2071 balance roundrobin
2072 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2073 stick on src
2074
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002075 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2076 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002077
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002078 Example:
2079 peers mypeers
2080 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2081 default-server ssl verify none
2082 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2083 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002084
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090020853.6. Mailers
2086------------
2087It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2088If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2089in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2090
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002091mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002092 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2093 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2094
2095mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2096 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2097
2098 Example:
2099 mailers mymailers
2100 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2101 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2102
2103 backend mybackend
2104 mode tcp
2105 balance roundrobin
2106
2107 email-alert mailers mymailers
2108 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2109 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2110
2111 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2112 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2113
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002114timeout mail <time>
2115 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2116 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2117 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2118 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2119
2120 Example:
2121 mailers mymailers
2122 timeout mail 20s
2123 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002124
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021254. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002126----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002127
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002128Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002129 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002130 - frontend <name>
2131 - backend <name>
2132 - listen <name>
2133
2134A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2135its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2136section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002137section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002138
2139A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2140connections.
2141
2142A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2143to forward incoming connections.
2144
2145A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2146parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2147
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002148All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2149'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2150case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2151
2152Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2153logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2154proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2155However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2156name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2157
2158Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2159and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002160bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002161protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2162modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2163arbitrary criteria.
2164
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002165In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2166a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002167the backend's. HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002168
2169 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2170 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2171 between responses and new requests.
2172
2173 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
2174 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
2175 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01002176 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
2177 And because it cannot work in HTTP/2, this option is deprecated and it is
2178 only supported on legacy HTTP frontends. In HTX, it is ignored and a
2179 warning is emitted during HAProxy startup.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002180
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002181 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2182 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2183 client-facing connection remains open.
2184
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002185 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2186 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002187
2188The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2189frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2190following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002191weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002192
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002193 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002194
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002195 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2196 ----+-----+-----+----
2197 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2198 ----+-----+-----+----
2199 TUN | TUN | SCL | CLO
2200 Frontend ----+-----+-----+----
2201 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2202 ----+-----+-----+----
2203 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002204
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002205
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002206
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022074.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2208--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002209
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002210The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2211limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2212they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2213limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002214marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002215option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002216and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2217with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2218specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002219
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002220
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002221 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2222------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2223acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002224backlog X X X -
2225balance X - X X
2226bind - X X -
2227bind-process X X X X
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002228block (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002229capture cookie - X X -
2230capture request header - X X -
2231capture response header - X X -
2232clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002233compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002234contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2235cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002236declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002237default-server X - X X
2238default_backend X X X -
2239description - X X X
2240disabled X X X X
2241dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002242email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002243email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002244email-alert mailers X X X X
2245email-alert myhostname X X X X
2246email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002247enabled X X X X
2248errorfile X X X X
2249errorloc X X X X
2250errorloc302 X X X X
2251-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2252errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002253force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002254filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002255fullconn X - X X
2256grace X X X X
2257hash-type X - X X
2258http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002259http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002260http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002261http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002262http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002263http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002264http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002265id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002266ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002267load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002268log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002269log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002270log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002271log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002272max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002273maxconn X X X -
2274mode X X X X
2275monitor fail - X X -
2276monitor-net X X X -
2277monitor-uri X X X -
2278option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2279option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2280option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2281option allbackups (*) X - X X
2282option checkcache (*) X - X X
2283option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2284option contstats (*) X X X -
2285option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2286option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Tim Duesterhus44864ac2019-05-06 01:19:53 +02002287option forceclose (deprecated) (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002288-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2289option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002290option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002291option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002292option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002293option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002294option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002295option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01002296option http-tunnel (deprecated) (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002297option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02002298option http-use-htx (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002299option httpchk X - X X
2300option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01002301option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002302option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002303option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002304option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002305option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002306option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2307option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2308option logasap (*) X X X -
2309option mysql-check X - X X
2310option nolinger (*) X X X X
2311option originalto X X X X
2312option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002313option pgsql-check X - X X
2314option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002315option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002316option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002317option smtpchk X - X X
2318option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2319option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2320option splice-request (*) X X X X
2321option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002322option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002323option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2324option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2325-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002326option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002327option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2328option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2329option tcpka X X X X
2330option tcplog X X X X
2331option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002332external-check command X - X X
2333external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002334persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2335rate-limit sessions X X X -
2336redirect - X X X
2337redisp (deprecated) X - X X
2338redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
2339reqadd - X X X
2340reqallow - X X X
2341reqdel - X X X
2342reqdeny - X X X
2343reqiallow - X X X
2344reqidel - X X X
2345reqideny - X X X
2346reqipass - X X X
2347reqirep - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002348reqitarpit - X X X
2349reqpass - X X X
2350reqrep - X X X
2351-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002352reqtarpit - X X X
2353retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02002354retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002355rspadd - X X X
2356rspdel - X X X
2357rspdeny - X X X
2358rspidel - X X X
2359rspideny - X X X
2360rspirep - X X X
2361rsprep - X X X
2362server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002363server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002364server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002365source X - X X
2366srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002367stats admin - X X X
2368stats auth X X X X
2369stats enable X X X X
2370stats hide-version X X X X
2371stats http-request - X X X
2372stats realm X X X X
2373stats refresh X X X X
2374stats scope X X X X
2375stats show-desc X X X X
2376stats show-legends X X X X
2377stats show-node X X X X
2378stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002379-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2380stick match - - X X
2381stick on - - X X
2382stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002383stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002384stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02002385tcp-check connect - - X X
2386tcp-check expect - - X X
2387tcp-check send - - X X
2388tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002389tcp-request connection - X X -
2390tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002391tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002392tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002393tcp-response content - - X X
2394tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002395timeout check X - X X
2396timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002397timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002398timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
2399timeout connect X - X X
2400timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2401timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2402timeout http-request X X X X
2403timeout queue X - X X
2404timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002405timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002406timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2407timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002408timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002409transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002410unique-id-format X X X -
2411unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002412use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002413use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002414------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2415 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002416
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002417
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020024184.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2419---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002420
2421This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2422
2423
2424acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2425 Declare or complete an access list.
2426 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2427 no | yes | yes | yes
2428 Example:
2429 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2430 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2431 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2432
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002433 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002434
2435
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002436backlog <conns>
2437 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2438 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2439 yes | yes | yes | no
2440 Arguments :
2441 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2442 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002443 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002444
2445 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2446 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2447 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2448 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2449 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2450 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2451 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2452 backlog parameter.
2453
2454 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2455 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2456 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2457
2458 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2459
2460
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002461balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002462balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002463 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2464 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2465 yes | no | yes | yes
2466 Arguments :
2467 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2468 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2469 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2470 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2471
2472 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2473 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2474 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2475 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002476 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002477 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002478 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2479 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2480 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2481 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2482 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2483 it, so that you don't worry.
2484
2485 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2486 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2487 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2488 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2489 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2490 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2491 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2492 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002493
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002494 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2495 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2496 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2497 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2498 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2499 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2500 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2501 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2502
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002503 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002504 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002505 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2506 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002507 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002508 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2509 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2510 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2511 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2512 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002513 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2514 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2515 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2516 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2517 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2518 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002519
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002520 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2521 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2522 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2523 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2524 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2525 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2526 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2527 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002528 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002529 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002530 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2531 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2532 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002533
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002534 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2535 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2536 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2537 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2538 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2539 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2540 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2541 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2542 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2543 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2544 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2545 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002546
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002547 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002548 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2549 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2550 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2551 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2552 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2553 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2554 URIs start with a leading "/".
2555
2556 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2557 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2558 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2559 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2560
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002561 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002562 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2563
2564 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002565 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2566 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002567 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2568 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2569 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2570 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002571 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002572 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2573 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002574
2575 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2576 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2577 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2578 server will receive the request.
2579
2580 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2581 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2582 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2583 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2584 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002585 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2586 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2587 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002588
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002589 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2590 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2591 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2592 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2593 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002594
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002595 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002596 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2597 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2598 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2599
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002600 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2601 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2602 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2603
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002604 random
2605 random(<draws>)
2606 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002607 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
2608 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
2609 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
2610 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002611 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
2612 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
2613 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
2614 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
2615 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
2616 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
2617 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
2618 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
2619 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
2620 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
2621 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
2622 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
2623 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
2624 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
2625 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
2626 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
2627 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
2628 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
2629 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
2630 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002631
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002632 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002633 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002634 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2635 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2636 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2637 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2638 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2639 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002640 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002641 used instead.
2642
2643 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2644 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2645 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2646 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2647
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002648 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2649 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2650 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2651
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002652 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002653
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002654 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002655 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2656 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002657
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002658 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2659 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2660 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002661
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002662 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
2663 based alghoritms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
2664 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
2665 NTLM relies on.
2666
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002667 Examples :
2668 balance roundrobin
2669 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002670 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002671 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2672 balance hdr(host)
2673 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002674
2675 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2676 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2677
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002678 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002679 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2680 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2681 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2682 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2683
2684 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2685 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2686 defaults to 16 kB.
2687
2688 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2689 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2690
2691 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2692 Round Robin.
2693
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00002694 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002695 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2696 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2697 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2698
2699 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2700
2701 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002702 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002703 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2704 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2705 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002706
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002707 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002708
2709
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002710bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2711bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002712 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2713 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2714 no | yes | yes | no
2715 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002716 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2717 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2718 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2719 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002720 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002721 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2722 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2723 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2724 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2725 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2726 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2727 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002728 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2729 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2730 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2731 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2732 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2733 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2734 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002735 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2736 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2737 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02002738 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
2739 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
2740 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
2741 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002742 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2743 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2744 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002745
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002746 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2747 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002748 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2749 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2750 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002751 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2752 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2753 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2754 the range.
2755
2756 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2757 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2758 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2759 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2760 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2761 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2762 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002763 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002764 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002765
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002766 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002767 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002768 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2769 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2770 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2771 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2772 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2773 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2774
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002775 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2776 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2777 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2778 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002779
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002780 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2781 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2782 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2783 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2784 in a frontend.
2785
2786 Example :
2787 listen http_proxy
2788 bind :80,:443
2789 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002790 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002791
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002792 listen http_https_proxy
2793 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002794 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002795
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002796 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2797 bind ipv6@:80
2798 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2799 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2800
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002801 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002802 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002803
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002804 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2805 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2806 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2807 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2808 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2809
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002810 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002811 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002812
2813
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002814bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002815 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2816 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2817 yes | yes | yes | yes
2818 Arguments :
2819 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2820 may be used to override a default value.
2821
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002822 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002823 option may be combined with other numbers.
2824
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002825 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002826 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2827 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2828 missing from all processes.
2829
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002830 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002831 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002832 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
2833 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
2834 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
2835 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
2836 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002837 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002838
2839 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2840 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2841 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2842 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2843 and 'even' instances.
2844
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002845 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2846 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2847 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2848 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002849
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002850 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2851 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2852
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002853 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2854 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2855 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2856
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002857 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2858 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2859
2860 Example :
2861 listen app_ip1
2862 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002863 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002864
2865 listen app_ip2
2866 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002867 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002868
2869 listen management
2870 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002871 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002872
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002873 listen management
2874 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2875 bind-process 1-4
2876
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002877 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002878
2879
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002880block { if | unless } <condition> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002881 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2882 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2883 no | yes | yes | yes
2884
2885 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
2886 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002887 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002888 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002889 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03002890 "block" statements per instance. To block connections at layer 4 (without
2891 sending a 403 error) see "tcp-request connection reject" and
2892 "tcp-request content reject" rules.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002893
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002894 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
2895 "http-request deny" instead.
2896
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002897 Example:
2898 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2899 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2900 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +03002901 # block is deprecated. Use http-request deny instead:
2902 #block if invalid_src || local_dst
2903 http-request deny if invalid_src || local_dst
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002904
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03002905 See also : section 7 about ACL usage, "http-request deny",
2906 "http-response deny", "tcp-request connection reject" and
2907 "tcp-request content reject".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002908
2909capture cookie <name> len <length>
2910 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2911 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2912 no | yes | yes | no
2913 Arguments :
2914 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2915 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2916 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2917 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002918 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002919
2920 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2921 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
2922 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2923 right if it exceeds <length>.
2924
2925 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2926 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2927 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2928 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2929
2930 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2931 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2932 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2933
2934 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2935 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2936 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002937 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2938 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2939 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002940
2941 Example:
2942 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2943
2944 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002945 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002946
2947
2948capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002949 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002950 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2951 no | yes | yes | no
2952 Arguments :
2953 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002954 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002955 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2956 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2957 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2958
2959 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2960 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2961 it exceeds <length>.
2962
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002963 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002964 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2965 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002966 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2967 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2968 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2969 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002970 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002971 environments to find where the request came from.
2972
2973 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2974 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2975 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2976 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002977
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002978 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2979 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2980 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2981 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2982 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002983
2984 Example:
2985 capture request header Host len 15
2986 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01002987 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002988
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002989 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002990 about logging.
2991
2992
2993capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002994 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002995 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2996 no | yes | yes | no
2997 Arguments :
2998 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002999 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003000 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3001 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3002 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3003
3004 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3005 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3006 it exceeds <length>.
3007
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003008 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003009 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3010 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3011 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003012 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3013 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3014 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3015 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003016
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003017 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3018 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3019 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3020 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3021 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003022
3023 Example:
3024 capture response header Content-length len 9
3025 capture response header Location len 15
3026
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003027 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003028 about logging.
3029
3030
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003031clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003032 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3033 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3034 yes | yes | yes | no
3035 Arguments :
3036 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
3037 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3038 as explained at the top of this document.
3039
3040 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
3041 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
3042 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
3043 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
3044 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
3045 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
3046 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
3047 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003048 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003049 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003050 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003051
3052 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
3053 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
3054 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
3055 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
3056 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
3057 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
3058
3059 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
3060 Please use "timeout client" instead.
3061
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01003062 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
3063 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003064
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003065compression algo <algorithm> ...
3066compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003067compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003068 Enable HTTP compression.
3069 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3070 yes | yes | yes | yes
3071 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003072 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3073 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3074 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3075
3076 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003077 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3078 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3079 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003080
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003081 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003082 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003083
3084 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3085 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3086 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3087 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3088 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003089 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003090
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003091 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3092 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3093 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3094 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3095 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3096 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3097 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003098 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003099
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003100 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003101 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003102 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3103 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3104 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3105 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3106 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003107
3108 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3109 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3110 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3111 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3112 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003113 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3114 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3115 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3116 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3117 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003118 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3119 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003120
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003121 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003122 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3123 "Accept-Encoding" header
3124 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003125 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003126 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3127 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3128 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3129 "multipart"
3130 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3131 header
3132 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3133 and later
3134 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3135 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003136 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003137
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003138 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003139
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003140 Examples :
3141 compression algo gzip
3142 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003143
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003144
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003145contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003146 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3147 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3148 yes | no | yes | yes
3149 Arguments :
3150 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
3151 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3152 as explained at the top of this document.
3153
3154 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003155 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003156 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003157 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003158 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
3159 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
3160 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
3161
3162 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
3163 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
3164 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
3165 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
3166 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
3167 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
3168
3169 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
3170 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
3171 instead.
3172
3173 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
3174 "timeout server", "contimeout".
3175
3176
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003177cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003178 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3179 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003180 [ dynamic ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003181 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3182 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3183 yes | no | yes | yes
3184 Arguments :
3185 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3186 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3187 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3188 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3189 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3190 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003191 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003192 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3193 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3194
3195 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3196 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3197 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3198 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3199 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3200 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003201 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3202 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003203 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003204 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3205 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003206
3207 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003208 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003209
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003210 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003211 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
3212 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003213 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003214 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3215 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3216 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3217 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3218 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3219 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3220 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003221
3222 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3223 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3224 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3225 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3226 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3227 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3228 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3229 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3230 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003231 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003232 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3233 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3234 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003235
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003236 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3237 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3238 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003239 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3240 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3241 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3242 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003243 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3244 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3245 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003246
3247 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3248 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3249 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3250 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3251 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3252 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3253 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3254 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3255 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3256
3257 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3258 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3259 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3260 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3261 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3262 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3263 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3264 persistence cookie in the cache.
3265 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3266
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003267 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3268 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3269 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3270 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3271 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003272 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003273 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3274 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3275 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3276 they logout.
3277
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003278 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3279 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3280 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3281 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3282
3283 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3284 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3285 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3286 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3287 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3288 this attribute.
3289
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003290 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003291 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003292 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3293 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3294 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3295 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3296 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3297 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003298
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003299 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3300 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3301 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3302 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3303 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3304 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3305 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3306 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003307 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003308 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3309 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3310 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3311 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3312 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3313 the site.
3314
3315 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3316 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3317 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3318 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3319 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3320 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3321 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3322 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3323 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3324 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3325 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3326 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3327 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003328 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003329 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3330 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3331
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003332 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3333 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3334 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3335 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3336 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3337 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3338
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003339 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3340 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3341 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3342 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003343
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003344 Examples :
3345 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3346 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3347 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003348 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003349
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003350 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003351
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003352
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003353declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3354 Declares a capture slot.
3355 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3356 no | yes | yes | no
3357 Arguments:
3358 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3359
3360 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3361 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3362 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3363 for use in the response.
3364
3365 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003366 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003367 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3368
3369
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003370default-server [param*]
3371 Change default options for a server in a backend
3372 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3373 yes | no | yes | yes
3374 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003375 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3376 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3377 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3378 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003379
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003380 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003381 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3382
3383 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003384
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003385
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003386default_backend <backend>
3387 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3388 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3389 yes | yes | yes | no
3390 Arguments :
3391 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3392
3393 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3394 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3395 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3396 will catch all undetermined requests.
3397
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003398 Example :
3399
3400 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3401 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3402 default_backend dynamic
3403
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003404 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003405
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003406
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003407description <string>
3408 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3409 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3410 no | yes | yes | yes
3411 Arguments : string
3412
3413 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3414 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3415 it describes.
3416 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3417
3418
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003419disabled
3420 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3421 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3422 yes | yes | yes | yes
3423 Arguments : none
3424
3425 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3426 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3427 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3428 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3429 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3430 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3431 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3432
3433 See also : "enabled"
3434
3435
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003436dispatch <address>:<port>
3437 Set a default server address
3438 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3439 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003440 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003441
3442 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3443 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3444 during start-up.
3445
3446 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3447 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3448 possible with normal servers.
3449
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003450 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003451 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3452 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3453 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3454 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3455
3456 See also : "server"
3457
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003458
3459dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3460 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3461 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3462 yes | no | yes | yes
3463 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3464
3465 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003466 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003467 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3468 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003469 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003470 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003471
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003472enabled
3473 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3474 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3475 yes | yes | yes | yes
3476 Arguments : none
3477
3478 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3479 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3480
3481 See also : "disabled"
3482
3483
3484errorfile <code> <file>
3485 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3486 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3487 yes | yes | yes | yes
3488 Arguments :
3489 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003490 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3491 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003492
3493 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003494 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003495 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003496 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3497 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003498
3499 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3500 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3501 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3502
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003503 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3504
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003505 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3506 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3507 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3508 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3509
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003510 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3511 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003512 not to put any reference to local contents (e.g. images) in order to avoid
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003513 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3514 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3515 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3516
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003517 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3518 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3519 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003520 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003521 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3522
3523 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3524
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003525 Example :
3526 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003527 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003528 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3529 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3530
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003531
3532errorloc <code> <url>
3533errorloc302 <code> <url>
3534 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3535 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3536 yes | yes | yes | yes
3537 Arguments :
3538 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003539 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3540 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003541
3542 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3543 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3544 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3545 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003546 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003547
3548 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3549 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3550 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3551
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003552 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3553
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003554 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3555 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3556 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3557 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003558 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003559 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3560 request.
3561
3562 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3563
3564
3565errorloc303 <code> <url>
3566 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3567 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3568 yes | yes | yes | yes
3569 Arguments :
3570 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003571 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3572 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003573
3574 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3575 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3576 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3577 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003578 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003579
3580 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3581 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3582 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3583
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003584 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3585
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003586 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3587 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3588 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3589 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003590 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003591
3592 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3593
3594
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003595email-alert from <emailaddr>
3596 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003597 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003598 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3599 yes | yes | yes | yes
3600
3601 Arguments :
3602
3603 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3604
3605 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3606 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3607
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003608 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003609 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3610 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003611
3612
3613email-alert level <level>
3614 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3615 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3616 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3617 yes | yes | yes | yes
3618
3619 Arguments :
3620
3621 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3622 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3623 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3624
3625 By default level is alert
3626
3627 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3628 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3629 for the proxy.
3630
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003631 Alerts are sent when :
3632
3633 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3634 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3635 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3636 is notice or lower
3637 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3638 and a health check status update occurs
3639
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003640 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3641 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003642 section 3.6 about mailers.
3643
3644
3645email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3646 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3647 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3648 yes | yes | yes | yes
3649
3650 Arguments :
3651
3652 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3653
3654 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3655 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3656
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003657 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3658 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003659
3660
3661email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3662 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3663 mailers.
3664 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3665 yes | yes | yes | yes
3666
3667 Arguments :
3668
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003669 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003670
3671 By default the systems hostname is used.
3672
3673 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3674 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3675 for the proxy.
3676
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003677 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3678 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003679
3680
3681email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003682 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003683 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3684 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3685 yes | yes | yes | yes
3686
3687 Arguments :
3688
3689 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3690
3691 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3692 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3693
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003694 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003695 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3696
3697
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003698force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3699 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3700 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003701 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003702
3703 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3704 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3705 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3706 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3707 marked down for maintenance operations.
3708
3709 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3710 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3711 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3712 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3713 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3714 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3715 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3716 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3717 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3718
3719 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3720 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3721 is used.
3722
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003723 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003724 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003725
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003726
3727filter <name> [param*]
3728 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3729 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3730 no | yes | yes | yes
3731 Arguments :
3732 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3733 referenced in section 9.
3734
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003735 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003736 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003737 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
3738 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003739
3740 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3741 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3742
3743 Example:
3744 listen
3745 bind *:80
3746
3747 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3748 filter compression
3749 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3750
3751 compression algo gzip
3752 compression offload
3753
3754 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3755
3756 See also : section 9.
3757
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003758
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003759fullconn <conns>
3760 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3761 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3762 yes | no | yes | yes
3763 Arguments :
3764 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3765 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3766
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003767 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003768 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003769 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003770 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3771 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3772 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3773 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3774 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003775 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003776
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003777 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3778 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003779 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3780 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3781 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003782
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003783 Example :
3784 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3785 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3786 # connections.
3787 backend dynamic
3788 fullconn 10000
3789 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3790 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3791
3792 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3793
3794
3795grace <time>
3796 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3797 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003798 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003799 Arguments :
3800 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3801 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3802 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3803
3804 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3805 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003806 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003807 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3808
3809 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3810 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3811 simplify it.
3812
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003813
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003814hash-balance-factor <factor>
3815 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
3816 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3817 yes | no | no | yes
3818 Arguments :
3819 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
3820 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01003821 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003822
3823 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
3824 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
3825 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
3826 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
3827 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
3828 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
3829 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
3830
3831 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
3832 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
3833 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
3834 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
3835 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
3836
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003837 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
3838 consistent hashing mechanism.
3839
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003840 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
3841
3842
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003843hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003844 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3845 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3846 yes | no | yes | yes
3847 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003848 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3849 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003850
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003851 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3852 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3853 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3854 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3855 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3856 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3857 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3858 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3859 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3860 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003861
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003862 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3863 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3864 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3865 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3866 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3867 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3868 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3869 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3870 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3871 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3872 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3873 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3874 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003875 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3876 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003877
3878 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3879
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003880 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003881 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3882 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3883 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003884 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3885 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
3886 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003887
3888 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
3889 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003890 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
3891 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
3892 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
3893 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3894
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003895 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3896 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3897 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3898 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3899 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
3900 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
3901 parameter.
3902
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01003903 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
3904 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
3905 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
3906 used on strings.
3907
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003908 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
3909
3910 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
3911 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
3912 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
3913 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
3914 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
3915 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
3916 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
3917 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
3918 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
3919 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
3920 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
3921 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003922
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003923 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
3924 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
3925 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003926
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003927 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003928
3929
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003930http-check disable-on-404
3931 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
3932 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003933 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003934 Arguments : none
3935
3936 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
3937 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
3938 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
3939 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
3940 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
3941 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
3942 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
3943 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003944 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
3945 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
3946 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
3947
3948 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
3949
3950
3951http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003952 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003953 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02003954 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003955 Arguments :
3956 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
3957 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003958 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003959 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
3960 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
3961 details on the supported keywords.
3962
3963 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
3964 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
3965 with the usual backslash ('\').
3966
3967 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
3968 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
3969 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
3970 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
3971 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
3972
3973 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003974 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003975 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
3976 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3977 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3978
3979 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003980 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003981 response's status code matches the expression. If the
3982 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3983 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3984 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
3985
3986 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003987 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003988 response's body contains this exact string. If the
3989 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3990 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
3991 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
3992 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003993 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003994 trace).
3995
3996 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003997 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003998 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
3999 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4000 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
4001 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
4002 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004003 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004004
4005 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
4006 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
4007 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
4008 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
4009 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
4010 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
4011 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
4012 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
4013
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01004014 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
4015 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
4016 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
4017
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004018 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
4019 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
4020
4021 Examples :
4022 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004023 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004024
4025 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004026 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004027
4028 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004029 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004030
4031 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004032 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004033
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004034 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004035
4036
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004037http-check send-state
4038 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
4039 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4040 yes | no | yes | yes
4041 Arguments : none
4042
4043 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
4044 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
4045 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
4046 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
4047 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
4048
4049 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
4050 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
4051 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
4052 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
4053 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08004054 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
4055 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
4056 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4057
4058 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
4059 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
4060 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4061
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004062 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
4063 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
4064 checked in multiple backends.
4065
4066 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
4067 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
4068
4069 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
4070 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
4071 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
4072 one fails.
4073
4074 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
4075 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
4076 connections on all servers of the same backend.
4077
4078 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
4079 server's queue.
4080
4081 Example of a header received by the application server :
4082 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
4083 scur=13/22; qcur=0
4084
4085 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
4086
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004087
4088http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004089 Access control for Layer 7 requests
4090
4091 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4092 no | yes | yes | yes
4093
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004094 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4095 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4096 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4097 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4098 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004099
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004100 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4101 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004102
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004103 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004104
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004105 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
4106 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
4107 or "reqadd" rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are
4108 visible by almost all further ACL rules.
Willy Tarreau53275e82017-11-24 07:52:01 +01004109
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004110 Using "reqadd"/"reqdel"/"reqrep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4111 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4112 delete headers, you can still use "reqdel". Also please use
4113 "http-request deny/allow/tarpit" instead of "reqdeny"/"reqpass"/"reqtarpit".
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01004114
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004115 Example:
4116 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4117 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4118 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004119
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004120 http-request allow if nagios
4121 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4122 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4123 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01004124
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004125 Example:
4126 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4127 acl add path /addacl
4128 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004129
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004130 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004131
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004132 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4133 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004134
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004135 Example:
4136 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4137 acl setmap path /setmap
4138 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004139
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004140 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004141
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004142 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4143 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004144
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004145 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4146 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004147
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004148http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004149
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004150 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4151 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4152 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4153 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4154 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
4155 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4156 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4157 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004158
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004159http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004160
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004161 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
4162 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
4163 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
4164 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
4165 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
4166 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
4167 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
4168 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004169
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004170http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004171
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004172 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
4173 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004174
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004175
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004176http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004177
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004178 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
4179 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
4180 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
4181 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
4182 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004183
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004184 Example:
4185 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
4186 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004187
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004188http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004189
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004190 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004191
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004192http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
4193 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004194
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004195 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
4196 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4197 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
4198 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
4199 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
4200 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
4201 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
4202 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
4203 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004204
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004205 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
4206 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
4207 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
4208 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword. If the slot
4209 <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration to prevent
4210 unexpected behavior at run time.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004211
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004212http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004213
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004214 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4215 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4216 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4217 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4218 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4219 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004220
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004221http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004222
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004223 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004224
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004225http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004226
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004227 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4228 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4229 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4230 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4231 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4232 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004233
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004234http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004235
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004236 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request
4237 and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
4238 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
4239 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive.
4240 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004241
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01004242http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
4243
4244 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
4245 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
4246 pointed by <resolvers>.
4247 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
4248 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
4249 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
4250 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
4251 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
4252 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
4253 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
4254 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
4255 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
4256 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
4257 to 0.0.0.0.
4258
4259 Example:
4260 resolvers mydns
4261 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
4262 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
4263 timeout retry 1s
4264 hold valid 10s
4265 hold nx 3s
4266 hold other 3s
4267 hold obsolete 0s
4268 accepted_payload_size 8192
4269
4270 frontend fe
4271 bind 10.42.0.1:80
4272 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
4273 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
4274
4275 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
4276 # which mean DNS resolution error
4277 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
4278
4279 default_backend be
4280
4281 backend b_503
4282 # dummy backend used to return 503.
4283 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
4284 # 503 error page to end users
4285
4286 backend be
4287 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
4288 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
4289 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
4290 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
4291 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
4292
4293 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
4294 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
4295
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004296http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4297
4298 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
4299 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
4300 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
4301 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01004302 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
4303 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004304
4305 See RFC 8297 for more information.
4306
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004307http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004308
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004309 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
4310 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
4311 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
4312 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
4313 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004314
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004315http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004316
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004317 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
4318 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
4319 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
4320 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004321
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004322http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4323 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02004324
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004325 This matches the regular expression in all occurrences of header field
4326 <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with the
4327 <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt and
4328 work like in <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header". The match is
4329 only case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
4330 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they may
4331 contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas in
4332 their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004333
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004334 Example:
4335 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004336
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004337 # applied to:
4338 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004339
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004340 # outputs:
4341 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004342
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004343 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004344
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004345http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4346 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004347
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004348 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4349 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
4350 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
4351 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004352
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004353 Example:
4354 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004355
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004356 # applied to:
4357 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004358
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004359 # outputs:
4360 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004361
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004362http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4363http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004364
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004365 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4366 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4367 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004368
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004369http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004370
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004371 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
4372 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
4373 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004374
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004375http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004376
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004377 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4378 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
4379 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
4380 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
4381 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004382
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004383 Arguments:
4384 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4385 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004386
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004387 Example:
4388 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4389 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004390
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004391 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
4392 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004393
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004394http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004395
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004396 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4397 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
4398 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004399
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004400 Arguments:
4401 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4402 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004403
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004404 Example:
4405 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4406 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004407
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004408 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4409 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4410 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004411
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004412http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004413
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004414 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
4415 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4416 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4417 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
4418 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004419
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004420 Example:
4421 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4422 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
4423 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
4424 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4425 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4426 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4427 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4428 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4429 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004430
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004431http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004432
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004433 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4434 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4435 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4436 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
4437 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004438
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004439http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
4440 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004441
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004442 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4443 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4444 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
4445 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
4446 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4447 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4448 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4449 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4450 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004451
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004452http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004453
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004454 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
4455 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
4456 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
4457 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
4458 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
4459 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
4460 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004461
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004462http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004463
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004464 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
4465 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
4466 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004467
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004468http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004469
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004470 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
4471 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
4472 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
4473 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
4474 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
4475 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
4476 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
4477 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004478
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004479http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004480
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004481 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
4482 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
4483 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
4484 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
4485 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
4486 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004487
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004488 Example :
4489 # prepend the host name before the path
4490 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004491
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004492http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02004493
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004494 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
4495 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
4496 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4497 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
4498 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004499
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004500http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004501
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004502 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
4503 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
4504 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4505 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
4506 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
4507 values have higher priority.
4508 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
4509 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
4510 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
4511 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
4512 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004513
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004514http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004515
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004516 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
4517 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
4518 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
4519 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
4520 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
4521 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
4522 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004523
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004524 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004525
4526 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004527 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
4528 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004529
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004530http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4531 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
4532 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
4533 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
4534 privacy.
4535
4536 Arguments :
4537 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4538 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004539
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004540 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004541 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
4542 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
4543
4544 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
4545 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
4546
4547http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4548
4549 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
4550 expression.
4551
4552 Arguments:
4553 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4554 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004555
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004556 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004557 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
4558 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
4559
4560 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
4561 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
4562 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4563
4564http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4565
4566 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
4567 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
4568 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
4569 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
4570 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
4571 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
4572 information from the request.
4573
4574 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4575
4576http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4577
4578 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
4579 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
4580 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
4581 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
4582 path and the query string.
4583 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
4584
4585http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4586
4587 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4588 inline.
4589
4590 Arguments:
4591 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4592 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4593 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4594 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4595 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4596 (request and response)
4597 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4598 processing
4599 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4600 processing
4601 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4602 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
4603 and '_'.
4604
4605 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4606 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004607
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004608 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004609 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004610
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004611http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
4612 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004613
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004614 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
4615 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
4616 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
4617 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
4618 agent name must be used.
4619
4620 Arguments:
4621 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
4622
4623 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4624 configuration.
4625
4626http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4627
4628 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
4629 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
4630 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
4631 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
4632 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
4633 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
4634 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
4635 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
4636 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
4637 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
4638 action.
4639 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
4640 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
4641 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
4642 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
4643 you fully understand how it works.
4644
4645http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4646
4647 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
4648 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
4649 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
4650 is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status code
4651 specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the client
4652 does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT".
4653 The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when
4654 they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
4655 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load
4656 on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
4657 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the front
4658 firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
4659 See also the "silent-drop" action.
4660
4661http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4662http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4663http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4664
4665 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
4666 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
4667 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
4668 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
4669 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
4670 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4671 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
4672 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
4673 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4674 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
4675 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
4676 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
4677
4678 Arguments :
4679 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
4680 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
4681 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
4682 select which table entry to update the counters.
4683
4684 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
4685 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
4686 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
4687 that table until the session ends.
4688
4689 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
4690 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
4691 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
4692 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
4693 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
4694 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
4695 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
4696 useful information.
4697
4698 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
4699 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
4700 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
4701 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
4702 checks that make use of it.
4703
4704http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4705
4706 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004707
4708 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004709 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004710
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004711http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004712
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004713 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
4714 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
4715 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004716
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004717
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004718http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004719 Access control for Layer 7 responses
4720
4721 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4722 no | yes | yes | yes
4723
4724 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4725 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4726 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4727 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4728 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4729 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4730
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004731 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4732 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004733
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004734 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004735
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004736 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
4737 the HTTP processing, before "rspdel" or "rsprep" or "rspadd" rules. That way,
4738 headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further
4739 ACL rules.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004740
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004741 Using "rspadd"/"rspdel"/"rsprep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4742 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4743 delete headers, you can still use "rspdel". Also please use
4744 "http-response deny" instead of "rspdeny".
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004745
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004746 Example:
4747 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004748
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004749 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004750
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004751 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4752 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004753
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004754 Example:
4755 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004756
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004757 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004758
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004759 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
4760 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004761
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004762 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4763 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004764
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004765http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004766
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004767 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4768 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4769 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4770 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4771 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
4772 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4773 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4774 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004775
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004776http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004777
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004778 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4779 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4780 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4781 example, or to pass some internal information.
4782 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4783 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4784 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004785
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004786http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004787
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004788 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4789 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004790
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004791http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004792
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004793 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004794
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004795http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004796
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004797 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
4798 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
4799 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
4800 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
4801 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
4802 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
4803 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004804
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004805 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
4806 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
4807 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
4808 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
4809 keyword.
4810 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration
4811 to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004812
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004813http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004814
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004815 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4816 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4817 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4818 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4819 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4820 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004821
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004822http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004823
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004824 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004825
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004826http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004827
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004828 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4829 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4830 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4831 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4832 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4833 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004834
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004835http-response deny [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004836
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004837 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response
4838 and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004839
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004840http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004841
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004842 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
4843 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
4844 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
4845 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
4846 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
4847 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004848
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004849http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4850 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004851
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004852 This matches the regular expression in all occurrences of header field <name>
4853 according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with the <replace-fmt> argument.
4854 Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt and work like in <fmt> arguments
4855 in "add-header". The match is only case-sensitive. It is important to
4856 understand that this action only considers whole header lines, regardless of
4857 the number of values they may contain. This usage is suited to headers
4858 naturally containing commas in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and
4859 so on.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004860
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004861 Example:
4862 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004863
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004864 # applied to:
4865 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004866
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004867 # outputs:
4868 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004869
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004870 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004871
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004872http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4873 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004874
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004875 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4876 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the entire
4877 header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry more than
4878 one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004879
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004880 Example:
4881 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004882
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004883 # applied to:
4884 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004885
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004886 # outputs:
4887 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004888
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004889http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4890http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004891
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004892 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4893 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4894 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004895
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004896http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004897
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004898 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
4899 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
4900 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004901
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004902http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004903
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004904 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
4905 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
4906 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
4907 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
4908 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004909
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004910 Arguments:
4911 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004912
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004913 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4914 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004915
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004916http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004917
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004918 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
4919 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
4920 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004921
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004922http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4923
4924 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4925 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4926 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4927 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
4928 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
4929
4930http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
4931
4932 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4933 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4934 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
4935 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
4936 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
4937 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
4938 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4939 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
4940 be triggered by an HTTP response.
4941
4942http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4943
4944 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
4945 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
4946 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
4947 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
4948 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
4949 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
4950 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
4951
4952http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4953
4954 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
4955 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
4956 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
4957 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
4958 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
4959 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
4960 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
4961 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
4962
4963http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
4964 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4965
4966 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
4967 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
4968 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
4969 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004970
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004971 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004972 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4973 http-response set-status 431
4974 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4975 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004976
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004977http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004978
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004979 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
4980 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
4981 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
4982 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
4983 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
4984 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
4985 based on some information from the request.
4986
4987 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4988
4989http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4990
4991 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4992 inline.
4993
4994 Arguments:
4995 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4996 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4997 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4998 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4999 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5000 (request and response)
5001 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5002 processing
5003 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5004 processing
5005 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5006 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5007 and '_'.
5008
5009 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5010 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005011
5012 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005013 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005014
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005015http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005016
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005017 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5018 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5019 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5020 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5021 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5022 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5023 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5024 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5025 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5026 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5027 action.
5028 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5029 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5030 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5031 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5032 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005033
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005034http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5035http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5036http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005037
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005038 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
5039 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
5040 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
5041 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
5042 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
5043 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
5044
5045http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5046
5047 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
5048 about <var-name>.
5049
5050 Example:
5051 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5052
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02005053
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005054http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
5055 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
5056
5057 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5058 yes | no | yes | yes
5059
5060 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005061 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
5062 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
5063 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005064
5065 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
5066
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005067 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
5068 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
5069 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
5070 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
5071 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
5072 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
5073 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
5074 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
5075 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
5076 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005077
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005078 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
5079 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
5080 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
5081 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
5082 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
5083 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
5084 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
5085 effects.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005086
5087 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
5088 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
5089 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
5090 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
5091 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
5092 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
5093 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
5094 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
5095 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweights the
5096 downsides of rare connection failures.
5097
5098 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
5099 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
5100 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
5101 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
5102 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
5103 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005104 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005105 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
5106 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
5107 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
5108 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
5109 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
5110
5111 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005112 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
5113 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
5114 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005115
5116 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005117 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005118
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02005119 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
5120 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005121
5122 No connection pool is involved, once a session dies, the last idle connection
5123 it was attached to is deleted at the same time. This ensures that connections
5124 may not last after all sessions are closed.
5125
5126 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
5127 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
5128 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
5129
5130 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
5131
5132
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005133http-send-name-header [<header>]
5134 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
5135
5136 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5137 yes | no | yes | yes
5138
5139 Arguments :
5140
5141 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
5142
5143 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005144 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005145 is added with the header string proved.
5146
5147 See also : "server"
5148
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005149id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02005150 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
5151 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5152 no | yes | yes | yes
5153 Arguments : none
5154
5155 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
5156 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
5157 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005158
5159
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005160ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5161 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
5162 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005163 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005164
5165 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
5166 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
5167 and running).
5168
5169 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5170 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
5171 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005172 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005173 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
5174
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005175 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5176 "unless" condition is met.
5177
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005178 Example:
5179 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
5180 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
5181 ignore-persist if url_static
5182
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005183 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
5184
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005185load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
5186 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
5187 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5188 yes | no | yes | yes
5189
5190 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
5191 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
5192 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005193 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005194 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
5195 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
5196 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
5197 over the stats socket and redirect output.
5198
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005199 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005200 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02005201 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005202
5203 Arguments:
5204 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
5205 named "server-state-file".
5206
5207 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
5208 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
5209 name is used as a file name.
5210
5211 none don't load any stat for this backend
5212
5213 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005214 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
5215 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
5216 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005217 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005218 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005219
5220 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
5221 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
5222
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005223 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005224
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005225 global
5226 stats socket /tmp/socket
5227 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005228
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005229 defaults
5230 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005231
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005232 backend bk
5233 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5234 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005235
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005236
5237 Then one can run :
5238
5239 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
5240
5241 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
5242
5243 1
5244 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5245 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5246 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5247
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005248 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005249
5250 global
5251 stats socket /tmp/socket
5252 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
5253
5254 defaults
5255 load-server-state-from-file local
5256
5257 backend bk
5258 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5259 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
5260
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005261
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005262 Then one can run :
5263
5264 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
5265
5266 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
5267
5268 1
5269 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5270 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5271 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5272
5273 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
5274 "show servers state"
5275
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005276
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005277log global
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02005278log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
5279 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005280no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005281 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
5282 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5283 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005284
5285 Prefix :
5286 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
5287 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
5288 prefix does not allow arguments.
5289
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005290 Arguments :
5291 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
5292 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
5293 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
5294 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
5295 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
5296 parameter.
5297
5298 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
5299 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
5300
5301 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
5302 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5303 standard syslog port).
5304
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01005305 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
5306 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5307 standard syslog port).
5308
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005309 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
5310 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
5311 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005312 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005313
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005314 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
5315 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
5316 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
5317 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
5318 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
5319 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
5320 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
5321 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
5322 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
5323 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
5324 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
5325 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
5326 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
5327 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
5328 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
5329 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005330 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
5331 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005332
5333 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
5334 and "fd@2", see above.
5335
5336 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
5337 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005338
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005339 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
5340 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
5341 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
5342 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
5343 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
5344 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
5345 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
5346 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
5347 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
5348 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005349 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005350
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02005351 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
5352 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
5353 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
5354 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
5355 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
5356
5357 <sample_size>
5358 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
5359 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
5360 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
5361 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
5362 (see also <ranges> parameter).
5363
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01005364 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
5365 one of the following :
5366
5367 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
5368 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
5369
5370 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
5371 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
5372
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005373 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
5374 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
5375 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
5376 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
5377 systemd logger consumes.
5378
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005379 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
5380 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
5381 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
5382 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
5383
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005384 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
5385
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005386 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
5387 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
5388 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
5389
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005390 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
5391 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
5392 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
5393 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005394
5395 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
5396 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
5397 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005398 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
5399 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
5400 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
5401 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
5402 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005403
5404 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
5405
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005406 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
5407 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
5408 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005409
5410 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
5411 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
5412 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
5413 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
5414
5415 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
5416 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005417
5418 Example :
5419 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005420 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
5421 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
5422 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005423 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
5424 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02005425 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005426
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005427
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005428log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005429 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
5430 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5431 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005432
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005433 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
5434 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
5435 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
5436 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
5437 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005438
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02005439 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
5440 "option httplog" directives.
5441
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02005442log-format-sd <string>
5443 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
5444 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5445 yes | yes | yes | no
5446
5447 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
5448 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
5449 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
5450 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
5451 which covers the log format string in depth.
5452
5453 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
5454 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
5455
5456 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
5457 log format to "rfc5424".
5458
5459 Example :
5460 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
5461
5462
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01005463log-tag <string>
5464 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
5465 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5466 yes | yes | yes | yes
5467
5468 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
5469 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
5470 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
5471 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
5472 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
5473 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
5474 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
5475 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
5476 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005477
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005478max-keep-alive-queue <value>
5479 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
5480 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5481 yes | no | yes | yes
5482
5483 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
5484 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
5485 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
5486 servers.
5487
5488 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
5489 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
5490 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
5491 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
5492 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005493 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005494 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
5495 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
5496 picking a different server.
5497
5498 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
5499 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
5500 even if they have to be queued.
5501
5502 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
5503 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
5504
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01005505max-session-srv-conns <nb>
5506 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
5507 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
5508 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005509
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005510maxconn <conns>
5511 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
5512 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5513 yes | yes | yes | no
5514 Arguments :
5515 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
5516 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
5517 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
5518 closes.
5519
5520 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
5521 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
5522 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
5523 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01005524 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
5525 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
5526 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
5527 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005528
5529 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
5530 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
5531 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
5532
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01005533 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
5534 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02005535
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005536 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
5537
5538
5539mode { tcp|http|health }
5540 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
5541 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5542 yes | yes | yes | yes
5543 Arguments :
5544 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
5545 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
5546 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
5547 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
5548
5549 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
5550 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
5551 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
5552 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
5553 brings HAProxy most of its value.
5554
5555 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005556 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
5557 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
5558 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
5559 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
5560 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
5561 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
5562 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005563
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005564 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
5565 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
5566 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005567
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005568 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005569 defaults http_instances
5570 mode http
5571
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005572 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005573
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005574
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005575monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005576 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005577 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5578 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005579 Arguments :
5580 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
5581 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005582 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005583 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
5584 backend and its backup.
5585
5586 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
5587 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
5588 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
5589 servers in a list of backends.
5590
5591 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
5592 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
5593 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
5594 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
5595 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
5596 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
5597 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005598 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
5599 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005600
5601 Example:
5602 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005603 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005604 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
5605 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
5606 monitor-uri /site_alive
5607 monitor fail if site_dead
5608
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005609 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005610
5611
5612monitor-net <source>
5613 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
5614 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5615 yes | yes | yes | no
5616 Arguments :
5617 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
5618 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
5619 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
5620 followed by a mask.
5621
5622 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
5623 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005624 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005625 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
5626
5627 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
5628 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
5629 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
5630 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005631 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
5632 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
5633 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005634
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005635 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
5636 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
5637 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
5638 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
5639 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
5640 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005641
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01005642 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
5643 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005644
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005645 Example :
5646 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
5647 frontend www
5648 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
5649
5650 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
5651
5652
5653monitor-uri <uri>
5654 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
5655 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5656 yes | yes | yes | no
5657 Arguments :
5658 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
5659 health status instead of forwarding the request.
5660
5661 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
5662 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
5663 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
5664 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
5665 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
5666 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
5667 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
5668 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
5669
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01005670 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
5671 and even before any "http-request" or "block" rulesets. The only rulesets
5672 applied before are the tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it
5673 is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an
5674 upper component, nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of
5675 conditions using "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted
5676 to whatever check can be imagined (most often the number of available servers
5677 in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005678
5679 Example :
5680 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
5681 frontend www
5682 mode http
5683 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
5684
5685 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
5686
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005687
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005688option abortonclose
5689no option abortonclose
5690 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
5691 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5692 yes | no | yes | yes
5693 Arguments : none
5694
5695 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
5696 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
5697 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
5698 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005699 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005700 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
5701 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
5702 encountered while delivering the response.
5703
5704 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
5705 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
5706 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
5707 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
5708 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
5709 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005710 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005711 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005712 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005713 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
5714 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
5715 still not served and not pollute the servers.
5716
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005717 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
5718 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005719 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
5720 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
5721 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
5722 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
5723 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
5724 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005725 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005726
5727 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5728 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5729
5730 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
5731
5732
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005733option accept-invalid-http-request
5734no option accept-invalid-http-request
5735 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
5736 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5737 yes | yes | yes | no
5738 Arguments : none
5739
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005740 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005741 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005742 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005743 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5744 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5745 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5746 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5747 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005748 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
5749 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
5750 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
5751 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005752 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005753 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02005754 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
5755 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
5756 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005757
5758 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5759 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5760 been confirmed.
5761
5762 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5763 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005764 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
5765 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005766 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5767
5768 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5769 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5770
5771 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
5772 stats socket.
5773
5774
5775option accept-invalid-http-response
5776no option accept-invalid-http-response
5777 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
5778 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5779 yes | no | yes | yes
5780 Arguments : none
5781
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005782 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005783 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005784 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005785 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5786 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5787 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5788 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5789 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005790 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
5791 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
5792 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005793
5794 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5795 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5796 been confirmed.
5797
5798 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5799 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
5800 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
5801 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5802
5803 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5804 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5805
5806 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
5807 stats socket.
5808
5809
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005810option allbackups
5811no option allbackups
5812 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
5813 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5814 yes | no | yes | yes
5815 Arguments : none
5816
5817 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
5818 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
5819 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
5820 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
5821 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
5822 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
5823 order between the backup servers anymore.
5824
5825 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
5826 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
5827
5828 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5829 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5830
5831
5832option checkcache
5833no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08005834 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005835 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5836 yes | no | yes | yes
5837 Arguments : none
5838
5839 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
5840 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005841 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005842 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
5843 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005844 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005845
5846 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005847 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005848 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005849 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
5850 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005851 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005852 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01005853 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
5854 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005855 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01005856 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
5857 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005858 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005859 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
5860 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
5861 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
5862 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
5863 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
5864 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
5865 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
5866 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
5867 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
5868
5869 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005870 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005871 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005872 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005873 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
5874
5875 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
5876 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005877 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005878 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005879
5880 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5881 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5882
5883
5884option clitcpka
5885no option clitcpka
5886 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
5887 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5888 yes | yes | yes | no
5889 Arguments : none
5890
5891 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5892 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005893 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005894 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5895
5896 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5897 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5898 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5899 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5900
5901 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5902 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5903 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5904 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5905 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5906
5907 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5908
5909 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5910 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5911 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
5912
5913 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5914 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5915
5916 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
5917
5918
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005919option contstats
5920 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
5921 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5922 yes | yes | yes | no
5923 Arguments : none
5924
5925 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
5926 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
5927 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
5928 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01005929 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
5930 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
5931 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
5932 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
5933 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005934
5935
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005936option dontlog-normal
5937no option dontlog-normal
5938 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
5939 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5940 yes | yes | yes | no
5941 Arguments : none
5942
5943 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
5944 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
5945 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
5946 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
5947 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
5948 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
5949 logged.
5950
5951 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
5952 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
5953 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
5954
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005955 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005956 logging.
5957
5958
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005959option dontlognull
5960no option dontlognull
5961 Enable or disable logging of null connections
5962 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5963 yes | yes | yes | no
5964 Arguments : none
5965
5966 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
5967 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
5968 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
5969 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
5970 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
5971 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005972 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
5973 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
5974 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005975
5976 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005977 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005978 would not be logged.
5979
5980 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5981 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5982
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005983 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
5984 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005985
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005986
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02005987option forceclose (deprecated)
5988no option forceclose (deprecated)
5989 This is an alias for "option httpclose". Thus this option is deprecated.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005990
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005991 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005992
5993
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005994option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005995 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
5996 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5997 yes | yes | yes | yes
5998 Arguments :
5999 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6000 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006001 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006002 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006003
6004 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
6005 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
6006 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
6007 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
6008 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
6009 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
6010 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006011 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
6012 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6013 possible that the client has already brought one.
6014
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006015 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006016 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006017 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006018 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006019 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006020 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006021
6022 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6023 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6024 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6025 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6026 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6027 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6028 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6029
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006030 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
6031 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
6032 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
6033 are under the control of the end-user.
6034
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006035 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006036 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6037 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006038 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
6039 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
6040 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006041
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006042 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006043 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
6044 frontend www
6045 mode http
6046 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
6047
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006048 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
6049 backend www
6050 mode http
6051 option forwardfor header X-Client
6052
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006053 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006054 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006055
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006056
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006057option http-buffer-request
6058no option http-buffer-request
6059 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
6060 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6061 yes | yes | yes | yes
6062 Arguments : none
6063
6064 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
6065 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
6066 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
6067 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
6068 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
6069 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
6070 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
6071 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01006072 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered transmissions between
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006073 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
6074 default.
6075
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01006076 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006077
6078
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006079option http-ignore-probes
6080no option http-ignore-probes
6081 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
6082 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6083 yes | yes | yes | no
6084 Arguments : none
6085
6086 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
6087 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
6088 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
6089 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
6090 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
6091 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
6092 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
6093 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
6094 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006095 was received over a connection before it was closed;
6096 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006097 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
6098
6099 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
6100 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
6101 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
6102 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
6103 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
6104 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
6105 are often the only way to detect them.
6106
6107 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6108 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6109
6110 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
6111
6112
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006113option http-keep-alive
6114no option http-keep-alive
6115 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
6116 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6117 yes | yes | yes | yes
6118 Arguments : none
6119
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006120 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6121 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006122 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6123 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
6124 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
6125 This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when
6126 another mode was used in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006127
6128 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
6129 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006130 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
6131 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
6132 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
6133 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
6134 situations where this option may be useful :
6135
6136 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006137 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006138
6139 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
6140 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
6141
6142 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
6143 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
6144 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
6145 request.
6146
6147 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
6148 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006149 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
6150 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
6151 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006152
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006153 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6154 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6155 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6156 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
6157 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6158 not set.
6159
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006160 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006161 http-server-close" or "option http-tunnel". When backend and frontend options
6162 differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006163
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006164 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006165 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01006166 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006167
6168
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006169option http-no-delay
6170no option http-no-delay
6171 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
6172 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6173 yes | yes | yes | yes
6174 Arguments : none
6175
6176 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
6177 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
6178 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
6179 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
6180 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
6181 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
6182 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
6183 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
6184 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
6185 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
6186 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
6187 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
6188 affected.
6189
6190 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
6191 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
6192 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
6193 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
6194 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
6195 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
6196 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
6197 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
6198 latency environments.
6199
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006200 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
6201
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006202
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006203option http-pretend-keepalive
6204no option http-pretend-keepalive
6205 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
6206 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006207 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006208 Arguments : none
6209
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006210 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006211 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
6212 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
6213 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
6214 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
6215 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
6216 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
6217 consider the response complete.
6218
6219 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
6220 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
6221 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
6222 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006223 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006224 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
6225
6226 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
6227 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
6228 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
6229 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
6230 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
6231 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
6232 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
6233
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006234 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
6235 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
6236 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6237 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
6238 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
6239 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006240
6241 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6242 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6243
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006244 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006245 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006246
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006247
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006248option http-server-close
6249no option http-server-close
6250 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
6251 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6252 yes | yes | yes | yes
6253 Arguments : none
6254
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006255 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6256 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6257 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6258 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006259 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
6260 Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the
6261 server side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and
6262 pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client
6263 side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save
6264 server resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits
6265 non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients
6266 if they conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers
6267 do not always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close"
6268 in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A
6269 workaround consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006270
6271 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6272 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6273 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6274 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006275 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6276 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006277
6278 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6279 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006280 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option http-tunnel"
6281 or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how
6282 this option combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006283
6284 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6285 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6286
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006287 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
6288 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006289
6290
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01006291option http-tunnel (deprecated)
6292no option http-tunnel (deprecated)
6293 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006294 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02006295 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006296 Arguments : none
6297
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01006298 Warning : Because it cannot work in HTTP/2, this option is deprecated and it
6299 is only supported on legacy HTTP frontends. In HTX, it is ignored and a
6300 warning is emitted during HAProxy startup.
6301
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006302 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6303 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6304 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6305 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006306 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006307
6308 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006309 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006310 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
6311 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
6312 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
6313 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
6314 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
6315 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
6316 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006317
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02006318 This option may be set on frontend and listen sections. Using it on a backend
6319 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during the startup. It
6320 is a frontend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6321 backend.
6322
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006323 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6324 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6325
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006326 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
6327 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006328
6329
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006330option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006331no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006332 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
6333 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6334 yes | yes | yes | no
6335 Arguments : none
6336
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00006337 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006338 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
6339 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
6340 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
6341 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
6342 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
6343 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
6344
6345 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
6346 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006347 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
6348 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
6349 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006350
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01006351 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
6352 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
6353 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
6354 front of an existing proxy.
6355
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006356 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
6357
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006358 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006359
6360
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006361option http-use-htx
6362no option http-use-htx
6363 Switch to the new HTX internal representation for HTTP protocol elements
6364 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6365 yes | yes | yes | yes
6366 Arguments : none
6367
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006368 Historically, the HTTP protocol is processed as-is. Inserting, deleting, or
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006369 modifying a header field requires to rewrite the affected part in the buffer
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006370 and to move the buffer's tail accordingly. This mode is known as the legacy
6371 HTTP mode. Since this principle has deep roots in haproxy, the HTTP/2
6372 protocol is converted to HTTP/1.1 before being processed this way. It also
6373 results in the inability to establish HTTP/2 connections to servers because
6374 of the loss of HTTP/2 semantics in the HTTP/1 representation.
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006375
6376 HTX is the name of a totally new native internal representation for the HTTP
6377 protocol, that is agnostic to the version and aims at preserving semantics
6378 all along the chain. It relies on a fast parsing, tokenizing and indexing of
6379 the protocol elements so that no more memory moves are necessary and that
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006380 most elements are directly accessed. It supports using either HTTP/1 or
6381 HTTP/2 on any side regardless of the other side's version. It also supports
6382 upgrades from TCP to HTTP and implicit ones from HTTP/1 to HTTP/2 (matching
6383 the HTTP/2 preface).
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006384
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006385 This option indicates that HTX needs to be used. Since the version 2.0-dev3,
6386 the HTX is the default mode. To switch back on the legacy HTTP mode, the
6387 option must be explicitly disabled using the "no" prefix. For prior versions,
6388 the feature has incomplete functional coverage, so it is not enabled by
6389 default.
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006390
6391 See also : "mode http"
6392
6393
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006394option httpchk
6395option httpchk <uri>
6396option httpchk <method> <uri>
6397option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
6398 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
6399 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6400 yes | no | yes | yes
6401 Arguments :
6402 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
6403 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
6404 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
6405 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
6406 ones.
6407
6408 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
6409 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
6410 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
6411
6412 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
6413 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
6414 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
6415 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
6416 after "\r\n" following the version string.
6417
6418 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
6419 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
6420 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
6421 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
6422 the lack of any response.
6423
6424 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
6425
6426 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
6427 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
6428 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
6429
6430 Examples :
6431 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
6432 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
6433 backend https_relay
6434 mode tcp
6435 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
6436 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
6437
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09006438 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
6439 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
6440 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006441
6442
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006443option httpclose
6444no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006445 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006446 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6447 yes | yes | yes | yes
6448 Arguments : none
6449
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006450 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6451 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6452 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6453 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006454 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006455
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006456 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
6457 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
6458 alos check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
6459 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
6460 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006461
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006462 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
6463 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
6464 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006465
6466 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6467 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006468 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006469 "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please check section 4
6470 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
6471 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006472
6473 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6474 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6475
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006476 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006477
6478
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006479option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006480 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
6481 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01006482 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006483 Arguments :
6484 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
6485 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
6486 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006487 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006488 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006489
6490 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6491 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6492 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
6493 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
6494 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
6495 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
6496 ports.
6497
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01006498 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
6499 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006500
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006501 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6502
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006503 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006504
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006505
6506option http_proxy
6507no option http_proxy
6508 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
6509 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6510 yes | yes | yes | yes
6511 Arguments : none
6512
6513 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
6514 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
6515 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
6516 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
6517 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
6518
6519 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
6520 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006521 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
6522 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006523
6524 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6525 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6526
6527 Example :
6528 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
6529 backend direct_forward
6530 option httpclose
6531 option http_proxy
6532
6533 See also : "option httpclose"
6534
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006535
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006536option independent-streams
6537no option independent-streams
6538 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006539 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6540 yes | yes | yes | yes
6541 Arguments : none
6542
6543 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
6544 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
6545 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
6546 receive data or not.
6547
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006548 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006549 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
6550 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
6551 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
6552 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
6553 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
6554 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
6555 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
6556 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
6557 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
6558 socket buffers.
6559
6560 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
6561 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
6562 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
6563 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
6564 slow lines, so use it with caution.
6565
Lukas Tribus745f15e2018-11-08 12:41:42 +01006566 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independant-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006567 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
6568 deprecated.
6569
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006570 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006571
6572
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02006573option ldap-check
6574 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
6575 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6576 yes | no | yes | yes
6577 Arguments : none
6578
6579 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
6580 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
6581 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
6582 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
6583
6584 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
6585 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
6586
6587 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
6588 configure it.
6589
6590 Example :
6591 option ldap-check
6592
6593 See also : "option httpchk"
6594
6595
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006596option external-check
6597 Use external processes for server health checks
6598 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6599 yes | no | yes | yes
6600
6601 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
6602 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
6603 command".
6604
6605 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
6606
6607 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
6608
6609
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006610option log-health-checks
6611no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006612 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006613 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6614 yes | no | yes | yes
6615 Arguments : none
6616
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006617 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
6618 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
6619 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006620
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006621 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
6622 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
6623 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
6624 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
6625 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
6626
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006627 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006628 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006629
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006630 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
6631 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
6632 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006633
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006634
6635option log-separate-errors
6636no option log-separate-errors
6637 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
6638 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6639 yes | yes | yes | no
6640 Arguments : none
6641
6642 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
6643 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
6644 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
6645 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
6646 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
6647 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
6648 provides very important information.
6649
6650 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
6651 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
6652 error logs.
6653
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006654 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006655 logging.
6656
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006657
6658option logasap
6659no option logasap
6660 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
6661 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6662 yes | yes | yes | no
6663 Arguments : none
6664
6665 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
6666 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
6667 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
6668 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
6669 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
6670 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
6671 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006672 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006673 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
6674 bytes are expected to be transferred.
6675
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006676 Examples :
6677 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
6678 mode http
6679 option httplog
6680 option logasap
6681 log 192.168.2.200 local3
6682
6683 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
6684 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
6685 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
6686 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
6687
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006688 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006689 logging.
6690
6691
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006692option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006693 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006694 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6695 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006696 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006697 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
6698 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006699 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006700
6701 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
6702 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006703 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006704 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
6705 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
6706 in the MySQL table, like this :
6707
6708 USE mysql;
6709 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
6710 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
6711
6712 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006713 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006714 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
6715 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
6716 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
6717 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
6718 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
6719 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
6720 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
6721
6722 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
6723 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006724
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02006725 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006726
6727 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
6728 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
6729 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6730 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006731 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
6732 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006733
6734 See also: "option httpchk"
6735
6736
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006737option nolinger
6738no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006739 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006740 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6741 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006742 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006743
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006744 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006745 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
6746 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
6747 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
6748 connections.
6749
6750 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
6751 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
6752 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
6753 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
6754 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
6755 this too.
6756
6757 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
6758 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
6759 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
6760
6761 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
6762 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
6763 for servers.
6764
6765 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6766 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6767
6768
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006769option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
6770 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
6771 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6772 yes | yes | yes | yes
6773 Arguments :
6774 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6775 matching <network>
6776 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
6777 header name.
6778
6779 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
6780 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
6781 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
6782 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
6783 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
6784 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
6785 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
6786 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
6787 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6788 possible that the client has already brought one.
6789
6790 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
6791 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
6792 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
6793 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
6794 header and requires different one.
6795
6796 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6797 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6798 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6799 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6800 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6801 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6802 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6803
6804 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
6805 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6806 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
6807 both are defined.
6808
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006809 Examples :
6810 # Original Destination address
6811 frontend www
6812 mode http
6813 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
6814
6815 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
6816 backend www
6817 mode http
6818 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
6819
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006820 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006821
6822
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006823option persist
6824no option persist
6825 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
6826 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6827 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006828 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006829
6830 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
6831 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
6832 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
6833 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
6834 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
6835 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
6836 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
6837 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
6838 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
6839 redirected to another valid server.
6840
6841 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6842 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6843
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006844 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006845
6846
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01006847option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
6848 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
6849 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6850 yes | no | yes | yes
6851 Arguments :
6852 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
6853 PostgreSQL server.
6854
6855 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
6856 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
6857 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
6858 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
6859
6860 See also: "option httpchk"
6861
6862
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006863option prefer-last-server
6864no option prefer-last-server
6865 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
6866 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6867 yes | no | yes | yes
6868 Arguments : none
6869
6870 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
6871 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
6872 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
6873 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
6874 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
6875 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
6876 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
6877 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
6878 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006879 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
6880 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02006881 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
6882 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
6883 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006884 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
6885 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
6886 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006887
6888 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6889 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6890
6891 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
6892
6893
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006894option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006895option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006896no option redispatch
6897 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6898 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6899 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006900 Arguments :
6901 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
6902 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
6903 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006904 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006905 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006906 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006907 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
6908 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
6909 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
6910
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006911
6912 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6913 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6914 be able to access the service anymore.
6915
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01006916 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
6917 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006918
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006919 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006920 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6921 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006922
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006923 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
6924 "redisp" keywords.
6925
6926 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6927 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6928
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006929 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006930
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006931
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006932option redis-check
6933 Use redis health checks for server testing
6934 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6935 yes | no | yes | yes
6936 Arguments : none
6937
6938 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
6939 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6940 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
6941 find the "+PONG" response message.
6942
6943 Example :
6944 option redis-check
6945
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006946 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006947
6948
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006949option smtpchk
6950option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
6951 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
6952 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6953 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006954 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006955 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02006956 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006957 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
6958
6959 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
6960 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
6961 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
6962
6963 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
6964 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
6965 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
6966 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
6967 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
6968 dead server.
6969
6970 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
6971 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006972 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006973 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
6974
6975 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
6976 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
6977 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6978 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006979 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006980
6981 Example :
6982 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
6983
6984 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
6985
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006986
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02006987option socket-stats
6988no option socket-stats
6989
6990 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
6991 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6992 yes | yes | yes | no
6993
6994 Arguments : none
6995
6996
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006997option splice-auto
6998no option splice-auto
6999 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
7000 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7001 yes | yes | yes | yes
7002 Arguments : none
7003
7004 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
7005 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007006 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007007 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007008 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007009 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
7010 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
7011 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
7012 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7013
7014 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
7015 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
7016 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
7017 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
7018 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
7019 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
7020 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
7021 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
7022 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
7023 keyword.
7024
7025 Example :
7026 option splice-auto
7027
7028 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7029 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7030
7031 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
7032 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7033
7034
7035option splice-request
7036no option splice-request
7037 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
7038 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7039 yes | yes | yes | yes
7040 Arguments : none
7041
7042 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007043 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007044 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7045 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7046 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7047 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7048
7049 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7050
7051 Example :
7052 option splice-request
7053
7054 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7055 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7056
7057 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
7058 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7059
7060
7061option splice-response
7062no option splice-response
7063 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
7064 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7065 yes | yes | yes | yes
7066 Arguments : none
7067
7068 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007069 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007070 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7071 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7072 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7073 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7074
7075 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7076
7077 Example :
7078 option splice-response
7079
7080 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7081 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7082
7083 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
7084 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7085
7086
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01007087option spop-check
7088 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
7089 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7090 no | no | no | yes
7091 Arguments : none
7092
7093 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
7094 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7095 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
7096 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
7097
7098 Example :
7099 option spop-check
7100
7101 See also : "option httpchk"
7102
7103
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007104option srvtcpka
7105no option srvtcpka
7106 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
7107 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7108 yes | no | yes | yes
7109 Arguments : none
7110
7111 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7112 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007113 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007114 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7115
7116 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7117 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7118 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7119 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7120
7121 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7122 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7123 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7124 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7125 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7126
7127 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7128
7129 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7130 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7131 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
7132
7133 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7134 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7135
7136 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
7137
7138
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007139option ssl-hello-chk
7140 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
7141 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7142 yes | no | yes | yes
7143 Arguments : none
7144
7145 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
7146 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
7147 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
7148 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
7149 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
7150 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
7151 hello message.
7152
7153 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
7154 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
7155 messages, which is appreciable.
7156
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007157 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
7158 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
7159 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007160
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007161 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
7162
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007163
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007164option tcp-check
7165 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
7166 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7167 yes | no | yes | yes
7168
7169 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
7170 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
7171
7172 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
7173 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
7174 attempt, which remains the default mode.
7175
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007176 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007177 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
7178 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
7179 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
7180 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
7181 only.
7182
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007183 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007184 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
7185 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
7186 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
7187 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
7188
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007189 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007190 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
7191 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007192 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007193 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
7194 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
7195 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
7196 the respective protocols.
7197 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007198 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007199
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007200 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
7201 script.
7202
7203 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
7204 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
7205 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
7206 The "comment" is of course optional.
7207
7208
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007209 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007210 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007211 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007212 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007213
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007214 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007215 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007216 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007217
7218 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
7219 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007220 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007221 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007222 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007223 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02007224 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007225 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007226 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7227 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007228 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007229 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7230 tcp-check expect string +OK
7231
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007232 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007233 (send many headers before analyzing)
7234 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007235 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007236 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
7237 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
7238 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
7239 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007240 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007241
7242
7243 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
7244
7245
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007246option tcp-smart-accept
7247no option tcp-smart-accept
7248 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
7249 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7250 yes | yes | yes | no
7251 Arguments : none
7252
7253 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
7254 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
7255 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
7256 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
7257 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
7258 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
7259
7260 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
7261 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
7262 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
7263 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
7264
7265 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
7266 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
7267 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007268 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007269
7270 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
7271 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
7272 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
7273
7274 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
7275 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
7276 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
7277
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02007278 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
7279
7280
7281option tcp-smart-connect
7282no option tcp-smart-connect
7283 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
7284 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7285 yes | no | yes | yes
7286 Arguments : none
7287
7288 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
7289 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
7290 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
7291 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
7292 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
7293
7294 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
7295 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
7296 complex.
7297
7298 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
7299 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
7300 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
7301
7302 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7303 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7304
7305 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
7306
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007307
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007308option tcpka
7309 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
7310 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7311 yes | yes | yes | yes
7312 Arguments : none
7313
7314 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7315 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007316 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007317 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7318
7319 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7320 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7321 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7322 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7323
7324 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7325 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7326 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7327 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7328 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7329
7330 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7331
7332 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
7333 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
7334 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
7335 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
7336 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
7337 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
7338 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
7339 backends.
7340
7341 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
7342
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007343
7344option tcplog
7345 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
7346 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007347 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007348 Arguments : none
7349
7350 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
7351 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
7352 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
7353 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
7354 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
7355 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
7356 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
7357 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
7358
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007359 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
7360
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007361 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007362
7363
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007364option transparent
7365no option transparent
7366 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7367 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007368 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007369 Arguments : none
7370
7371 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
7372 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
7373 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7374 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7375 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7376 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7377 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7378 appropriate server.
7379
7380 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7381 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7382
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01007383 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007384 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007385
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007386
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007387external-check command <command>
7388 Executable to run when performing an external-check
7389 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7390 yes | no | yes | yes
7391
7392 Arguments :
7393 <command> is the external command to run
7394
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007395 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
7396
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007397 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007398
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007399 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
7400 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
7401 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
7402 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
7403 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
7404 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007405
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01007406 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
7407
7408 Environment variables :
7409 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
7410 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
7411
7412 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
7413
7414 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
7415
7416 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
7417 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
7418 for a UNIX socket).
7419
7420 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
7421
7422 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
7423
7424 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
7425
7426 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
7427
7428 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
7429
7430 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
7431 socket).
7432
7433 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
7434 the command may be set using "external-check path".
7435
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007436 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
7437 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
7438 failed.
7439
7440 Example :
7441 external-check command /bin/true
7442
7443 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
7444
7445
7446external-check path <path>
7447 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
7448 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7449 yes | no | yes | yes
7450
7451 Arguments :
7452 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
7453
7454 The default path is "".
7455
7456 Example :
7457 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
7458
7459 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
7460 "external-check command"
7461
7462
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007463persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007464persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007465 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
7466 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7467 yes | no | yes | yes
7468 Arguments :
7469 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007470 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
7471 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007472
7473 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
7474 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007475 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007476 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
7477 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
7478 forwarded to this server.
7479
7480 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
7481 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
7482 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007483 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007484 a single "listen" section.
7485
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007486 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
7487 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
7488 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
7489
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007490 Example :
7491 listen tse-farm
7492 bind :3389
7493 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
7494 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7495 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
7496 # apply RDP cookie persistence
7497 persist rdp-cookie
7498 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007499 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007500 balance rdp-cookie
7501 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
7502 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
7503
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09007504 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
7505 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007506
7507
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007508rate-limit sessions <rate>
7509 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
7510 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7511 yes | yes | yes | no
7512 Arguments :
7513 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
7514 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
7515
7516 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
7517 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
7518 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
7519 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
7520 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
7521 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
7522
7523 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
7524 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
7525 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
7526 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
7527
7528 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
7529 listen smtp
7530 mode tcp
7531 bind :25
7532 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02007533 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007534
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02007535 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
7536 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
7537 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007538
7539 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
7540
7541
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007542redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7543redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7544redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007545 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
7546 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7547 no | yes | yes | yes
7548
7549 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01007550 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007551
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007552 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007553 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007554 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
7555 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
7556 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007557
7558 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
7559 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
7560 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
7561 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
7562 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007563 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
7564 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
7565 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
7566 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007567
7568 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
7569 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
7570 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
7571 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
7572 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
7573 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007574 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007575 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007576 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
7577 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
7578 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007579
7580 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007581 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
7582 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
7583 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02007584 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007585 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
7586 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
7587 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
7588 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007589
7590 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007591 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007592
7593 - "drop-query"
7594 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
7595 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
7596 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
7597 with a location-type redirect.
7598
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007599 - "append-slash"
7600 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
7601 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
7602 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
7603 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
7604
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007605 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
7606 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
7607 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
7608 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
7609 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
7610 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
7611 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
7612
7613 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
7614 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
7615 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
7616 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
7617 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
7618 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
7619 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007620
7621 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
7622 acl clear dst_port 80
7623 acl secure dst_port 8080
7624 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007625 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007626 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007627 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
7628
7629 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007630 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
7631 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
7632 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007633 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007634
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007635 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
7636 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
7637 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
7638
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007639 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01007640 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007641
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007642 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02007643 http-request redirect code 301 location \
7644 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
7645 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007646
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007647 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007648
7649
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007650redisp (deprecated)
7651redispatch (deprecated)
7652 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7653 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7654 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007655 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007656
7657 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7658 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7659 be able to access the service anymore.
7660
7661 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
7662 redistribute them to a working server.
7663
7664 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
7665 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7666 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007667
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007668 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
7669 "option redispatch" instead.
7670
7671 See also : "option redispatch"
7672
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007673
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007674reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007675 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
7676 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7677 no | yes | yes | yes
7678 Arguments :
7679 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7680 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007681 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007682
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007683 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7684 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7685
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007686 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7687 the last header of an HTTP request.
7688
7689 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7690 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7691 responses.
7692
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007693 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
7694 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
7695 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
7696
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007697 See also: "rspadd", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation,
7698 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007699
7700
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007701reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7702reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007703 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7704 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7705 no | yes | yes | yes
7706 Arguments :
7707 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7708 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7709 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7710 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7711 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7712 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
7713 ignores case.
7714
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007715 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7716 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7717
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007718 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7719 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
7720 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7721 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007722 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007723
7724 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7725 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7726
7727 Example :
7728 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
7729 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7730 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7731
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007732 See also: "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header
7733 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007734
7735
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007736reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7737reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007738 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
7739 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7740 no | yes | yes | yes
7741 Arguments :
7742 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7743 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7744 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7745 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7746 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
7747 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
7748
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007749 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7750 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7751
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007752 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
7753 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
7754 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
7755 next servers.
7756
7757 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7758 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7759 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7760
7761 Example :
7762 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
7763 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
7764 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
7765
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007766 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", "http-request", section 6 about
7767 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007768
7769
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007770reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7771reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007772 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7773 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7774 no | yes | yes | yes
7775 Arguments :
7776 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7777 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7778 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7779 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7780 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7781 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
7782 case.
7783
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007784 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7785 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7786
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007787 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7788 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
7789 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7790 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007791 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007792
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007793 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007794 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007795 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007796
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007797 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7798 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7799
7800 Example :
7801 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
7802 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7803 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7804
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007805 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7806 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007807
7808
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007809reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7810reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007811 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
7812 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7813 no | yes | yes | yes
7814 Arguments :
7815 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7816 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7817 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7818 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7819 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7820 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
7821 case.
7822
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007823 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7824 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7825
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007826 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7827 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
7828 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
7829 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7830
7831 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7832 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7833
7834 Example :
7835 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
7836 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
7837 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7838 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7839
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007840 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7841 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007842
7843
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007844reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7845reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007846 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
7847 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7848 no | yes | yes | yes
7849 Arguments :
7850 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7851 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7852 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7853 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7854 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
7855 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
7856
7857 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7858 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7859 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7860 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007861 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007862
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007863 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7864 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7865
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007866 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
7867 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
7868 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
7869
7870 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7871 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7872 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7873 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
7874 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7875
7876 Example :
7877 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007878 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007879 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
7880 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
7881
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007882 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", "http-request",
7883 section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007884
7885
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007886reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7887reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007888 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
7889 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7890 no | yes | yes | yes
7891 Arguments :
7892 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7893 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7894 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7895 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7896 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7897 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
7898 ignores case.
7899
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007900 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7901 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7902
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007903 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7904 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007905 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
7906 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
7907 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007908 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
7909 not set.
7910
7911 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
7912 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
7913 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
7914 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
7915 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
7916
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007917 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007918 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavor of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007919 # block all others.
7920 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
7921 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
7922
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007923 # block bad guys
7924 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
7925 reqitarpit . if badguys
7926
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007927 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", "http-request", section 6
7928 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007929
7930
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007931retries <value>
7932 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
7933 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7934 yes | no | yes | yes
7935 Arguments :
7936 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
7937 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
7938 default value is 3.
7939
7940 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
7941 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
7942 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
7943
7944 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007945 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
7946 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007947
7948 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
7949 server even if a cookie references a different server.
7950
7951 See also : "option redispatch"
7952
7953
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02007954retry-on [list of keywords]
7955 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request
7956 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7957 yes | no | yes | yes
7958 Arguments :
7959 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
7960 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
7961 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
7962 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
7963
7964 none never retry
7965
7966 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
7967 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
7968
7969 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
7970 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
7971 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
7972 request timeout on the server side, poor network
7973 condition, or a server crash or restart while
7974 processing the request.
7975
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02007976 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
7977 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
7978 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
7979 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
7980 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
7981 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
7982 overflow attack for example).
7983
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02007984 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
7985 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
7986 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
7987 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
7988 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
7989 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
7990 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
7991 amplify denial of service attacks.
7992
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02007993 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
7994 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
7995 considered to be safe to retry.
7996
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02007997 <status> any HTTP status code among "404" (Not Found), "408"
7998 (Request Timeout), "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server
7999 Error), "501" (Not Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway),
8000 "503" (Service Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
8001
8002 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
8003 not cumulative.
8004
8005 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
8006 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
8007 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
8008 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
8009
8010 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
8011 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
8012 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
8013 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
8014 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
8015 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
8016 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
8017 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
8018 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
8019 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
8020 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
8021 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
8022
8023 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
8024 should not use this directive.
8025
8026 The default is "conn-failure".
8027
8028 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
8029
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008030rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008031 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
8032 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8033 no | yes | yes | yes
8034 Arguments :
8035 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
8036 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008037 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008038
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008039 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8040 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8041
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008042 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
8043 the last header of an HTTP response.
8044
8045 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8046 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8047 responses.
8048
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008049 See also: "rspdel" "reqadd", "http-response", section 6 about HTTP header
8050 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008051
8052
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008053rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
8054rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008055 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
8056 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8057 no | yes | yes | yes
8058 Arguments :
8059 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8060 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
8061 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
8062 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
8063 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
8064 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
8065 ignores case.
8066
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008067 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8068 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8069
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008070 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
8071 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008072 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008073 client.
8074
8075 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8076 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8077 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
8078
8079 Example :
8080 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02008081 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008082
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008083 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", "http-response", section 6 about
8084 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008085
8086
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008087rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
8088rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008089 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
8090 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8091 no | yes | yes | yes
8092 Arguments :
8093 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8094 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
8095 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
8096 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
8097 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
8098 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
8099 ignores case.
8100
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008101 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8102 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8103
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008104 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
8105 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
8106 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
8107 case-sensitive.
8108
8109 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008110 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
8111 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
8112 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008113
8114 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
8115 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
8116
8117 Example :
8118 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
8119 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
8120
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008121 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", "http-response", section 6 about
8122 HTTP header manipulation and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008123
8124
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008125rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
8126rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008127 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
8128 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8129 no | yes | yes | yes
8130 Arguments :
8131 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8132 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
8133 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
8134 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
8135 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
8136 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
8137 ignores case.
8138
8139 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
8140 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
8141 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
8142 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008143 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008144
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008145 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8146 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8147
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008148 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
8149 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
8150 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
8151
8152 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8153 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8154 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
8155 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
8156 are not case-sensitive.
8157
8158 Example :
8159 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
8160 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
8161
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008162 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", "http-response", section 6 about
8163 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008164
8165
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008166server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008167 Declare a server in a backend
8168 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8169 no | no | yes | yes
8170 Arguments :
8171 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008172 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008173 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008174
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008175 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
8176 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
8177 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
8178 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02008179 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
8180 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
8181 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
8182 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
8183 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008184 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
8185 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
8186 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
8187 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
8188 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8189 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8190 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008191 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02008192 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
8193 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
8194 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
8195 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
8196 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
8197 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008198 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8199 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01008200 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
8201 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008202
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008203 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008204 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
8205 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
8206 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
8207 adding this value to the client's port.
8208
8209 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
8210 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008211 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008212
8213 Examples :
8214 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
8215 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008216 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008217 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
8218 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
8219 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008220
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02008221 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
8222 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
8223 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
8224 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
8225 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
8226
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008227 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
8228 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008229
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008230server-state-file-name [<file>]
8231 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
8232 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
8233 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
8234 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
8235 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
8236 global directive "server-state-file-base".
8237
8238 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
8239 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
8240
8241 global
8242 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
8243
8244 backend bk
8245 load-server-state-from-file
8246
8247 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
8248 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008249
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02008250server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
8251 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
8252 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
8253 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8254 no | no | yes | yes
8255
8256 Arguments:
8257 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
8258
8259 <num | range>
8260 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
8261 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
8262 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
8263 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
8264
8265 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
8266
8267 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
8268
8269 <params*>
8270 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
8271 keyword.
8272
8273 Examples:
8274 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
8275 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
8276 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
8277
8278 # or
8279 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
8280
8281 # would be equivalent to:
8282 server srv1 google.com:80 check
8283 server srv2 google.com:80 check
8284 server srv3 google.com:80 check
8285
8286
8287
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008288source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008289source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008290source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008291 Set the source address for outgoing connections
8292 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8293 yes | no | yes | yes
8294 Arguments :
8295 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
8296 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008297
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008298 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008299 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
8300 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
8301 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
8302 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
8303 supported prefixes are :
8304 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8305 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8306 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008307 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02008308 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8309 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008310
8311 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
8312 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008313 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
8314 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
8315 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008316
8317 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
8318 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
8319 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
8320 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
8321 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
8322 <addr>.
8323
8324 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
8325 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
8326 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
8327 port.
8328
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008329 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
8330 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
8331 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
8332 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01008333 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008334 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
8335 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
8336 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
8337 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
8338 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
8339 HTTP header.
8340
8341 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
8342 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008343 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008344 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
8345 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8346 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
8347 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
8348 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
8349 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
8350 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
8351
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008352 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
8353 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
8354 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
8355 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
8356 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
8357 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
8358
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008359 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
8360 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
8361 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
8362 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
8363
8364 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
8365 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
8366 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
8367 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
8368 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
8369 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
8370
8371 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
8372 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
8373 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
8374 there are two methods :
8375
8376 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
8377 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
8378 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
8379 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
8380 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
8381 of the client ranges may be used.
8382
8383 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
8384 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
8385 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
8386 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
8387 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
8388 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
8389 same session.
8390
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008391 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
8392 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
8393 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008394 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008395
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02008396 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
8397
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008398 Examples :
8399 backend private
8400 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
8401 source 192.168.1.200
8402
8403 backend transparent_ssl1
8404 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
8405 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8406
8407 backend transparent_ssl2
8408 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
8409 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
8410 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
8411
8412 backend transparent_ssl3
8413 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
8414 # is more conntrack-friendly.
8415 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8416
8417 backend transparent_smtp
8418 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
8419 # with Tproxy version 4.
8420 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
8421
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008422 backend transparent_http
8423 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
8424 # proxy.
8425 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
8426
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008427 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008428 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
8429
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008430
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008431srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8432 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
8433 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8434 yes | no | yes | yes
8435 Arguments :
8436 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8437 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8438 as explained at the top of this document.
8439
8440 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8441 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
8442 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
8443 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
8444 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
8445 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
8446 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
8447
8448 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8449 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8450 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
8451 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
8452 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008453 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008454 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008455 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008456
8457 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8458 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8459 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8460 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8461 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8462 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8463
8464 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
8465 Please use "timeout server" instead.
8466
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008467 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
8468 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008469
8470
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008471stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
8472 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
8473 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008474 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008475
8476 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
8477 matched.
8478
8479 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
8480 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
8481
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008482 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8483 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008484 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008485
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01008486 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
8487 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
8488 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
8489 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008490
8491 Example :
8492 # statistics admin level only for localhost
8493 backend stats_localhost
8494 stats enable
8495 stats admin if LOCALHOST
8496
8497 Example :
8498 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
8499 backend stats_auth
8500 stats enable
8501 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
8502 stats admin if TRUE
8503
8504 Example :
8505 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
8506 userlist stats-auth
8507 group admin users admin
8508 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
8509 group readonly users haproxy
8510 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
8511
8512 backend stats_auth
8513 stats enable
8514 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
8515 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
8516 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
8517 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
8518
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008519 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
8520 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
8521 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008522
8523
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008524stats auth <user>:<passwd>
8525 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
8526 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008527 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008528 Arguments :
8529 <user> is a user name to grant access to
8530
8531 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
8532
8533 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
8534 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
8535 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
8536 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
8537 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
8538 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
8539
8540 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
8541 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
8542 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008543 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008544
8545 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
8546 report using "stats scope".
8547
8548 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8549 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8550 unobvious parameters.
8551
8552 Example :
8553 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8554 backend public_www
8555 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8556 stats enable
8557 stats hide-version
8558 stats scope .
8559 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008560 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008561 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8562 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8563
8564 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8565 backend private_monitoring
8566 stats enable
8567 stats uri /admin?stats
8568 stats refresh 5s
8569
8570 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
8571
8572
8573stats enable
8574 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
8575 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008576 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008577 Arguments : none
8578
8579 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
8580 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
8581 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
8582 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
8583 - stats auth : no authentication
8584 - stats scope : no restriction
8585
8586 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8587 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8588 unobvious parameters.
8589
8590 Example :
8591 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8592 backend public_www
8593 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8594 stats enable
8595 stats hide-version
8596 stats scope .
8597 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008598 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008599 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8600 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8601
8602 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8603 backend private_monitoring
8604 stats enable
8605 stats uri /admin?stats
8606 stats refresh 5s
8607
8608 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8609
8610
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008611stats hide-version
8612 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008613 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008614 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008615 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008616
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008617 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
8618 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
8619 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
8620 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
8621 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
8622 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008623
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008624 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8625 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8626 unobvious parameters.
8627
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008628 Example :
8629 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8630 backend public_www
8631 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008632 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008633 stats hide-version
8634 stats scope .
8635 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008636 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008637 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8638 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008639
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008640 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8641 backend private_monitoring
8642 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008643 stats uri /admin?stats
8644 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01008645
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008646 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008647
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008648
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02008649stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
8650 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8651 Access control for statistics
8652
8653 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8654 no | no | yes | yes
8655
8656 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
8657 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
8658 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
8659 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
8660 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
8661 should be asked to enter a username and password.
8662
8663 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
8664 instance.
8665
8666 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
8667 about ACL usage.
8668
8669
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008670stats realm <realm>
8671 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
8672 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008673 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008674 Arguments :
8675 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
8676 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
8677 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
8678
8679 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
8680 using a backslash ('\').
8681
8682 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
8683 only related to authentication.
8684
8685 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8686 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8687 unobvious parameters.
8688
8689 Example :
8690 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8691 backend public_www
8692 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8693 stats enable
8694 stats hide-version
8695 stats scope .
8696 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008697 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008698 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8699 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8700
8701 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8702 backend private_monitoring
8703 stats enable
8704 stats uri /admin?stats
8705 stats refresh 5s
8706
8707 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
8708
8709
8710stats refresh <delay>
8711 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
8712 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008713 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008714 Arguments :
8715 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
8716 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
8717 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
8718 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
8719 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
8720 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
8721
8722 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
8723 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
8724 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
8725 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
8726
8727 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8728 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8729 unobvious parameters.
8730
8731 Example :
8732 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8733 backend public_www
8734 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8735 stats enable
8736 stats hide-version
8737 stats scope .
8738 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008739 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008740 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8741 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8742
8743 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8744 backend private_monitoring
8745 stats enable
8746 stats uri /admin?stats
8747 stats refresh 5s
8748
8749 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8750
8751
8752stats scope { <name> | "." }
8753 Enable statistics and limit access scope
8754 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008755 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008756 Arguments :
8757 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
8758 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
8759 section in which the statement appears.
8760
8761 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
8762 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
8763 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
8764 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
8765 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
8766 exists.
8767
8768 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8769 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8770 unobvious parameters.
8771
8772 Example :
8773 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8774 backend public_www
8775 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8776 stats enable
8777 stats hide-version
8778 stats scope .
8779 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008780 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008781 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8782 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8783
8784 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8785 backend private_monitoring
8786 stats enable
8787 stats uri /admin?stats
8788 stats refresh 5s
8789
8790 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8791
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008792
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008793stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008794 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
8795 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008796 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008797
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008798 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008799 description from global section is automatically used instead.
8800
8801 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8802 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
8803
8804 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8805 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008806 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008807
8808 Example :
8809 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8810 backend private_monitoring
8811 stats enable
8812 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
8813 stats uri /admin?stats
8814 stats refresh 5s
8815
8816 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
8817 global section.
8818
8819
8820stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008821 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
8822 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8823 yes | yes | yes | yes
8824 Arguments : none
8825
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008826 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008827 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
8828 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
8829 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
8830 - IP (socket, server)
8831 - cookie (backend, server)
8832
8833 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8834 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008835 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008836
8837 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
8838
8839
8840stats show-node [ <name> ]
8841 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
8842 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008843 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008844 Arguments:
8845 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
8846 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
8847
8848 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8849 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008850 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008851
8852 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8853 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8854 unobvious parameters.
8855
8856 Example:
8857 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8858 backend private_monitoring
8859 stats enable
8860 stats show-node Europe-1
8861 stats uri /admin?stats
8862 stats refresh 5s
8863
8864 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
8865 section.
8866
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008867
8868stats uri <prefix>
8869 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
8870 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008871 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008872 Arguments :
8873 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
8874 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
8875 query string.
8876
8877 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
8878 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
8879 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
8880 possible to reach it in the application.
8881
8882 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008883 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008884 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
8885 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
8886 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
8887 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
8888
8889 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
8890 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
8891 an address or a port to statistics only.
8892
8893 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8894 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8895 unobvious parameters.
8896
8897 Example :
8898 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8899 backend public_www
8900 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8901 stats enable
8902 stats hide-version
8903 stats scope .
8904 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008905 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008906 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8907 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8908
8909 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8910 backend private_monitoring
8911 stats enable
8912 stats uri /admin?stats
8913 stats refresh 5s
8914
8915 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
8916
8917
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008918stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
8919 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008920 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008921 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008922
8923 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008924 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008925 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008926 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008927 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
8928
8929 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8930 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8931 the "stick-table" statement.
8932
8933 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
8934 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
8935 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
8936 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
8937 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
8938
8939 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8940 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
8941 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
8942 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
8943 transformation rules.
8944
8945 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8946 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8947 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8948 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8949 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8950 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8951 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8952
8953 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
8954 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
8955 ACL based conditions.
8956
8957 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
8958 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
8959 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
8960 matches can be used as fallbacks.
8961
8962 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
8963 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
8964 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
8965 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
8966
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008967 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8968 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008969 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008970
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008971 Example :
8972 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8973 # last 30 minutes
8974 backend pop
8975 mode tcp
8976 balance roundrobin
8977 stick store-request src
8978 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8979 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8980 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8981
8982 backend smtp
8983 mode tcp
8984 balance roundrobin
8985 stick match src table pop
8986 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8987 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8988
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008989 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008990 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008991
8992
8993stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8994 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
8995 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8996 no | no | yes | yes
8997
8998 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
8999 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
9000 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
9001 for writing more maintainable configurations.
9002
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009003 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9004 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009005 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009006
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009007 Examples :
9008 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01009009 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009010
9011 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
9012 stick match src table pop if !localhost
9013 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
9014
9015
9016 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
9017 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
9018 backend http
9019 mode http
9020 balance roundrobin
9021 stick on src table https
9022 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
9023 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
9024 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
9025
9026 backend https
9027 mode tcp
9028 balance roundrobin
9029 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9030 stick on src
9031 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9032 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9033
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009034 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009035
9036
9037stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9038 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
9039 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9040 no | no | yes | yes
9041
9042 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009043 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009044 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009045 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009046 server is selected.
9047
9048 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9049 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9050 the "stick-table" statement.
9051
9052 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9053 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9054 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
9055 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
9056 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
9057 address.
9058
9059 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9060 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
9061 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
9062 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
9063 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
9064 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
9065 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
9066 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
9067 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
9068 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
9069
9070 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9071 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9072 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9073 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9074 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9075 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9076 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9077
9078 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
9079 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9080 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
9081 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9082
9083 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
9084 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9085 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9086 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9087 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9088 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009089 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
9090 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9091 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9092 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9093 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9094 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009095
9096 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
9097 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
9098 the request.
9099
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009100 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9101 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009102 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009103
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009104 Example :
9105 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9106 # last 30 minutes
9107 backend pop
9108 mode tcp
9109 balance roundrobin
9110 stick store-request src
9111 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9112 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9113 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9114
9115 backend smtp
9116 mode tcp
9117 balance roundrobin
9118 stick match src table pop
9119 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9120 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9121
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009122 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009123 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009124
9125
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009126stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009127 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
9128 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08009129 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009130 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009131 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009132
9133 Arguments :
9134 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
9135 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
9136 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9137 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9138
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01009139 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
9140 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
9141 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9142 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9143
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009144 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
9145 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
9146 instance.
9147
9148 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
9149 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
9150 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
9151 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
9152 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
9153 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009154 to 32 characters.
9155
9156 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
9157 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
9158 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009159 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009160 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
9161 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009162
9163 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009164 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
9165 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009166 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
9167 increase.
9168
9169 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009170 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
9171 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
9172 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009173
9174 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
9175 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
9176 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
9177 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009178 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009179 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
9180 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
9181 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
9182 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
9183 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
9184 parameter (see below).
9185
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009186 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
9187 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
9188 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
9189 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
9190 soft restart.
9191
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02009192 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
9193 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009194
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009195 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
9196 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
9197 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
9198 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009199 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009200 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009201 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
9202 if not expiration delay is specified.
9203
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009204 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
9205 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
9206 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
9207 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009208 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
9209 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
9210 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
9211 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
9212 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
9213 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
9214 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
9215 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
9216 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
9217 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
9218 types and their arguments.
9219
9220 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
9221 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
9222 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
9223 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
9224
9225 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9226 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9227 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009228 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009229
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009230 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
9231 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9232 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009233 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009234 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009235 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009236
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009237 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9238 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9239 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
9240 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
9241
9242 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
9243 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9244 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
9245 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
9246 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
9247 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
9248
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009249 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9250 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
9251 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
9252 they were received.
9253
9254 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9255 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
9256 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
9257 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
9258 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
9259
9260 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9261 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9262 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9263 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
9264 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9265
9266 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9267 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
9268 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
9269
9270 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9271 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9272 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9273 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
9274 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9275
9276 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9277 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
9278 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
9279 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
9280 the client side.
9281
9282 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9283 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9284 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9285 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
9286 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
9287 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
9288 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
9289
9290 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9291 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
9292 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
9293 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
9294 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
9295 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009296 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009297
9298 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9299 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9300 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9301 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
9302 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
9303 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9304
9305 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009306 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009307 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
9308 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
9309
9310 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9311 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9312 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9313 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9314 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9315 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
9316 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
9317 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
9318 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
9319 recommended for better fairness.
9320
9321 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009322 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009323 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
9324 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
9325
9326 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
9327 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9328 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9329 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9330 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9331 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
9332 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
9333 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
9334 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
9335 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009336
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009337 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
9338 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009339 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
9340 reference it.
9341
9342 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
9343 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01009344 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
9345 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
9346 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009347
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009348 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
9349 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
9350 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
9351 something that can be ignored.
9352
9353 Example:
9354 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
9355 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
9356 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
9357 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
9358
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009359 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01009360 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009361
9362
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009363stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01009364 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009365 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9366 no | no | yes | yes
9367
9368 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009369 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009370 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009371 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009372 server is selected.
9373
9374 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9375 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9376 the "stick-table" statement.
9377
9378 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9379 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9380 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
9381 when the response is a SSL server hello.
9382
9383 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9384 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
9385 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
9386 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
9387 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
9388 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009389 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009390 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
9391 rules.
9392
9393 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9394 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9395 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9396 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9397 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9398 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9399 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9400
9401 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
9402 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9403 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
9404 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9405
9406 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
9407 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9408 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9409 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9410 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9411 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009412 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
9413 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9414 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9415 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9416 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9417 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
9418 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
9419 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
9420 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009421
9422 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
9423
9424 Example :
9425 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
9426 backend https
9427 mode tcp
9428 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009429 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009430 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009431
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009432 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
9433 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
9434
9435 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
9436 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9437 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
9438
9439 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
9440 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009441
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009442 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
9443 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
9444 # at offset 44.
9445
9446 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
9447 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
9448
9449 # Learn on response if server hello.
9450 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009451
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009452 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9453 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9454
9455 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
9456 extraction.
9457
9458
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009459tcp-check connect [params*]
9460 Opens a new connection
9461 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9462 no | no | yes | yes
9463
9464 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
9465 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
9466 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
9467
9468 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
9469 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
9470 of the sequence.
9471
9472 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
9473 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
9474 do.
9475
9476 Parameters :
9477 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
9478 use the TCP connection.
9479
9480 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
9481 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
9482 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
9483
9484 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
9485
9486 ssl opens a ciphered connection
9487
9488 Examples:
9489 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
9490 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
9491 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
9492 option tcp-check
9493 tcp-check connect
9494 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9495 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9496 tcp-check send \r\n
9497 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9498 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
9499 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9500 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9501 tcp-check send \r\n
9502 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9503 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
9504
9505 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
9506 option tcp-check
9507 tcp-check connect port 110
9508 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9509 tcp-check connect port 143
9510 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9511 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
9512
9513 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
9514
9515
9516tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009517 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009518 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9519 no | no | yes | yes
9520
9521 Arguments :
9522 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
9523 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
9524 binary.
9525 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
9526 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
9527 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
9528
9529 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
9530 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
9531 with the usual backslash ('\').
9532 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009533 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009534 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
9535 used upper or lower case.
9536
9537
9538 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
9539
9540 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
9541 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9542 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
9543 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9544 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
9545 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
9546 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
9547 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
9548
9549 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
9550 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9551 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
9552 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9553 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
9554 expression.
9555
9556 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
9557 in the response buffer. A health check response will
9558 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
9559 this exact hexadecimal string.
9560 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
9561
9562 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
9563 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
9564 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
9565 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
9566 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
9567 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
9568 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
9569 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
9570 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
9571 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
9572 the null character.
9573
9574 Examples :
9575 # perform a POP check
9576 option tcp-check
9577 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9578
9579 # perform an IMAP check
9580 option tcp-check
9581 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9582
9583 # look for the redis master server
9584 option tcp-check
9585 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009586 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009587 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9588 tcp-check expect string role:master
9589 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9590 tcp-check expect string +OK
9591
9592
9593 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
9594 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
9595
9596
9597tcp-check send <data>
9598 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9599 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9600 no | no | yes | yes
9601
9602 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9603 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
9604
9605 Examples :
9606 # look for the redis master server
9607 option tcp-check
9608 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9609 tcp-check expect string role:master
9610
9611 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9612 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
9613
9614
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009615tcp-check send-binary <hexstring>
9616 Specify a hex digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009617 tcp health check
9618 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9619 no | no | yes | yes
9620
9621 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9622 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009623 <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009624 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
9625 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
9626 hexadecimal string.
9627 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
9628
9629 Examples :
9630 # redis check in binary
9631 option tcp-check
9632 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
9633 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
9634
9635
9636 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9637 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
9638
9639
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009640tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9641 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009642 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9643 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009644 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009645 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9646 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009647
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009648 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009649
9650 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
9651 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009652 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
9653 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
9654 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
9655 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
9656 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
9657 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009658
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009659 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9660 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9661 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
9662 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009663
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009664 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009665 - accept :
9666 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9667 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9668 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009669
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009670 - reject :
9671 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9672 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9673 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
9674 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
9675 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
9676 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
9677 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
9678 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
9679 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
9680 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
9681 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009682 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009683
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009684 - expect-proxy layer4 :
9685 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
9686 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
9687 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
9688 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
9689 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
9690 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
9691 hosts.
9692
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01009693 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
9694 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
9695 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
9696 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
9697 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
9698 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
9699 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
9700 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
9701
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009702 - capture <sample> len <length> :
9703 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
9704 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
9705 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
9706 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
9707 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
9708 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
9709 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
9710 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009711 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
9712 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009713
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009714 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009715 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +02009716 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
9717 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
9718 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
9719 haproxy -vv) whichs defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
9720 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
9721 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
9722 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
9723 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
9724 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
9725 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
9726 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
9727 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009728
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009729 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009730 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009731 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009732 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009733 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
9734 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
9735 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009736
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009737 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
9738 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
9739 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
9740 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009741
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009742 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
9743 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
9744 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
9745 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
9746 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009747 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
9748 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
9749 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
9750 layer7 information is extracted.
9751
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009752 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
9753 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
9754 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
9755 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
9756 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009757
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009758 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9759 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9760 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9761 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9762
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009763 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
9764 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
9765 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9766 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9767
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009768 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
9769 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9770 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9771 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9772 continues.
9773
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009774 - set-src <expr> :
9775 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
9776 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
9777 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009778 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009779
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009780 Arguments:
9781 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9782 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009783
9784 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009785 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
9786
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009787 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
9788 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009789
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009790 - set-src-port <expr> :
9791 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
9792 expression.
9793
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009794 Arguments:
9795 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9796 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009797
9798 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009799 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
9800
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009801 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
9802 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
9803 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009804
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009805 - set-dst <expr> :
9806 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
9807 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
9808 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9809 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9810 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9811
9812 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9813 followed by some converters.
9814
9815 Example:
9816
9817 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
9818 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
9819
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009820 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
9821 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
9822
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009823 - set-dst-port <expr> :
9824 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
9825 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9826 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9827
9828
9829 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9830 followed by some converters.
9831
9832 Example:
9833
9834 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
9835
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009836 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
9837 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
9838 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
9839
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009840 - "silent-drop" :
9841 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009842 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009843 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9844 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9845 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9846 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9847 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009848 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
9849 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009850 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9851 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009852 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009853 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9854 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9855 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9856 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9857
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009858 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9859 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9860 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009861
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009862 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9863 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
9864 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009865
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009866 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009867 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009868 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009869
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009870 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
9871 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9872 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009873
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009874 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009875 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9876 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009877
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009878 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
9879
9880 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9881
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009882 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9883
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009884 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009885
9886
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009887tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9888 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009889 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009890 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009891 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009892 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9893 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009894
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009895 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009896
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009897 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009898 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9899 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
9900 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
9901 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009902
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009903 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
9904 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
9905 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
9906 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009907 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
9908 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
9909 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
9910 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
9911 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
9912 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009913 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009914 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009915
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009916 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9917 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9918 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9919 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009920
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009921 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009922 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01009923 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009924 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9925 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04009926 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009927 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009928 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009929 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Thierry Fournierb9125672016-03-29 19:34:37 +02009930 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +02009931 - set-dst <expr>
9932 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009933 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009934 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009935 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009936 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009937
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009938 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
9939 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01009940 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
9941 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009942
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009943 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
9944 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
9945 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
9946 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
9947 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
9948 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009949
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009950 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009951 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9952 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009953
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009954 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009955 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
9956 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
9957 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
9958 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009959 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
9960 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
9961 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009962
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009963 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009964 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
9965 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
9966 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009967
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +02009968 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
9969 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
9970
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009971 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009972 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
9973 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009974
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009975 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9976 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009977 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009978 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9979 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009980 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009981 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009982 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009983 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9984 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009985 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009986 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9987 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009988
9989 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9990 followed by some converters.
9991
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009992 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9993 <var-name>.
9994
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04009995 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
9996 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
9997 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
9998 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
9999 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
10000
10001 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
10002 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
10003 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
10004 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
10005 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
10006 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
10007 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
10008 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
10009 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
10010 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
10011 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
10012
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010013 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10014 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10015 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10016 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10017 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10018
10019 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10020
10021 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10022
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010023 Example:
10024
10025 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010026 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010027
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010028 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010029 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
10030 # and reject everything else.
10031 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
10032 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020010033 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010034 tcp-request content reject
10035
10036 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010037 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
10038 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
10039 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010040 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010041
10042 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
10043 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
10044 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010045 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010046 tcp-request content reject
10047
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010048 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010049 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010050 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010051 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010052 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
10053 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010054
10055 Example:
10056 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
10057 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010058 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010059
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010060 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010061 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010062
10063 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010064 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010065 # protecting all our sites
10066 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010067 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
10068 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010069 ...
10070 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
10071
10072 backend http_dynamic
10073 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010074 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010075 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010076 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010077 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010078 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010079 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010080
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010081 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010082
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030010083 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
10084 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010085
10086
10087tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
10088 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
10089 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010090 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010091 Arguments :
10092 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10093 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10094 as explained at the top of this document.
10095
10096 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
10097 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
10098 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
10099 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
10100 data for at most the specified amount of time.
10101
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010102 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
10103 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
10104 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
10105 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
10106
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010107 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
10108 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010109 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010110 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010010111 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
10112 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
10113 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
10114 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010115
10116 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
10117 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
10118 it pass through unaffected.
10119
10120 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
10121 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
10122 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010123 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010124 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
10125 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020010126 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
10127 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
10128 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010129
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010130 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010131 "timeout client".
10132
10133
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010134tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10135 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
10136 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10137 no | no | yes | yes
10138 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010139 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10140 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010141
10142 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10143
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010144 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010145 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10146 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010147 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
10148 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010149
10150 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
10151
10152 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10153 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10154 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10155 inserted.
10156
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010157 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010158 - accept :
10159 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10160 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10161 the rules evaluation.
10162
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010163 - close :
10164 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
10165 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
10166 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
10167 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
10168 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
10169 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010170 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010171 protocols.
10172
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010173 - reject :
10174 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10175 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010176 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010177
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010178 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
10179 Sets a variable.
10180
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010181 - unset-var(<var-name>)
10182 Unsets a variable.
10183
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010184 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10185 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10186 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10187 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10188
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010189 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10190 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10191 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10192 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10193
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010194 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
10195 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
10196 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
10197 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
10198 continues.
10199
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010200 - "silent-drop" :
10201 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010202 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010203 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10204 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10205 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10206 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10207 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010208 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10209 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010210 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10211 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010212 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010213 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10214 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10215 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10216 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10217
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010218 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
10219 Send a group of SPOE messages.
10220
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010221 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10222 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10223 for changing the default action to a reject.
10224
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010225 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
10226 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
10227 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
10228 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010229 period.
10230
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010231 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
10232 declared inline.
10233
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010234 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10235 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010236 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010237 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10238 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010239 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010240 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010241 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010242 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10243 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010244 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010245 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10246 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010247
10248 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10249 followed by some converters.
10250
10251 Example:
10252
10253 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
10254
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010255 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10256 <var-name>.
10257
10258 Example:
10259
10260 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
10261
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010262 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10263 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10264 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10265 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10266 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10267
10268 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10269
10270 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10271
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010272 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10273
10274 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
10275
10276
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010277tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10278 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
10279 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10280 no | yes | yes | no
10281 Arguments :
10282 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10283 below.
10284
10285 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10286
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010287 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010288 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
10289 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
10290 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
10291 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
10292 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
10293 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
10294 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010295 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010296 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
10297 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
10298 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
10299 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
10300 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
10301 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
10302 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
10303 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
10304 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
10305 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
10306 instead.
10307
10308 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10309 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10310 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
10311 rules which may be inserted.
10312
10313 Several types of actions are supported :
10314 - accept : the request is accepted
10315 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10316 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
10317 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010318 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010319 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
10320 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010321 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010322 - silent-drop
10323
10324 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
10325 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
10326 sections for a complete description.
10327
10328 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10329 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10330 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
10331
10332 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
10333 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
10334 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
10335 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
10336 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
10337
10338 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10339 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10340
10341 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10342 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
10343 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
10344
10345 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10346 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
10347 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10348
10349 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
10350 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10351 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
10352
10353 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10354 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10355 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
10356
10357 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10358
10359 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
10360
10361
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010362tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
10363 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
10364 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10365 no | no | yes | yes
10366 Arguments :
10367 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10368 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10369 as explained at the top of this document.
10370
10371 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
10372
10373
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010374timeout check <timeout>
10375 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
10376 established.
10377
10378 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10379 yes | no | yes | yes
10380 Arguments:
10381 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10382 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10383 as explained at the top of this document.
10384
10385 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
10386 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010387 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010388 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010010389 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
10390 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
10391 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010392
10393 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
10394 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
10395
10396 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
10397 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010398 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010399
10400 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10401 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10402 forget about it.
10403
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010404 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
10405 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010406
10407
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010408timeout client <timeout>
10409timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10410 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
10411 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10412 yes | yes | yes | no
10413 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010414 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010415 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10416 as explained at the top of this document.
10417
10418 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10419 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10420 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010421 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
10422 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
10423 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
10424 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010425 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
10426 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
10427 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010428 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010429 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010430 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
10431 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010432 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
10433 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010434
10435 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10436 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10437 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10438 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
10439 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
10440 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10441
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010442 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010443
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010444 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
10445 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
10446 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10447
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010448 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel",
10449 "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010450
10451
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010452timeout client-fin <timeout>
10453 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
10454 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10455 yes | yes | yes | no
10456 Arguments :
10457 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10458 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10459 as explained at the top of this document.
10460
10461 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10462 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10463 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10464 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10465 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
10466 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10467 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010010468 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
10469 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
10470 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010471
10472 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10473 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10474 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
10475
10476 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
10477
10478
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010479timeout connect <timeout>
10480timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10481 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
10482 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10483 yes | no | yes | yes
10484 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010485 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010486 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10487 as explained at the top of this document.
10488
10489 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010490 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010491 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010492 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010493 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
10494 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010495
10496 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10497 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10498 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10499 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
10500 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
10501 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10502
10503 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
10504 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
10505 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10506
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010507 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
10508 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010509
10510
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010511timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
10512 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
10513 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10514 yes | yes | yes | yes
10515 Arguments :
10516 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10517 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10518 as explained at the top of this document.
10519
10520 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
10521 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
10522 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
10523 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
10524 once the request has started to present itself.
10525
10526 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
10527 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
10528 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
10529 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
10530 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
10531
10532 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
10533 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
10534 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
10535 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
10536
10537 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
10538 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010539 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010540 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
10541 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020010542 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010543
10544 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
10545 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
10546 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
10547 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
10548
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010549 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
10550 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010551 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
10552
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010553 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
10554
10555
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010556timeout http-request <timeout>
10557 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
10558 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010559 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010560 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010561 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010562 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10563 as explained at the top of this document.
10564
10565 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
10566 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
10567 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
10568 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
10569 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
10570 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
10571 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020010572 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
10573 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
10574 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
10575 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010576 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010577 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
10578 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010579
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010580 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
10581 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
10582 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
10583 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
10584 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010585 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010586
10587 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
10588 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010589 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010590 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
10591 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
10592
10593 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010594 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
10595 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
10596 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010597
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010598 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010599 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010600
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010601
10602timeout queue <timeout>
10603 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
10604 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10605 yes | no | yes | yes
10606 Arguments :
10607 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10608 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10609 as explained at the top of this document.
10610
10611 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
10612 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
10613 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
10614 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
10615 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
10616
10617 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
10618 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
10619 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
10620 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
10621
10622 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
10623
10624
10625timeout server <timeout>
10626timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10627 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
10628 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10629 yes | no | yes | yes
10630 Arguments :
10631 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10632 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10633 as explained at the top of this document.
10634
10635 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10636 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10637 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
10638 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
10639 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
10640 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
10641 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
10642
10643 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10644 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10645 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
10646 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
10647 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010648 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010649 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010650 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
10651 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010652 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
10653 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010654
10655 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10656 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10657 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10658 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
10659 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
10660 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10661
10662 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
10663 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
10664 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10665
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010666 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010667
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010668
10669timeout server-fin <timeout>
10670 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
10671 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10672 yes | no | yes | yes
10673 Arguments :
10674 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10675 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10676 as explained at the top of this document.
10677
10678 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10679 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10680 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10681 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10682 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
10683 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10684 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
10685 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
10686 situations, it should not be needed.
10687
10688 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10689 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10690 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
10691
10692 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
10693
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010694
10695timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010696 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010697 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10698 yes | yes | yes | yes
10699 Arguments :
10700 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
10701 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10702 as explained at the top of this document.
10703
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010704 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit" or
10705 "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with no activity for a certain
10706 amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit" defines how long it will
10707 be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010708
10709 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10710 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10711 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
10712 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010713 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010714
10715 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
10716
10717
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010718timeout tunnel <timeout>
10719 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
10720 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10721 yes | no | yes | yes
10722 Arguments :
10723 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10724 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10725 as explained at the top of this document.
10726
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010727 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010728 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
10729 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
10730 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010731 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
10732 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010733 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
10734 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
10735 specified.
10736
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010737 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
10738 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
10739 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
10740 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
10741 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
10742 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
10743 state.
10744
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010745 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10746 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10747 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
10748 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010749 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010750
10751 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10752 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10753 forget about it.
10754
10755 Example :
10756 defaults http
10757 option http-server-close
10758 timeout connect 5s
10759 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010760 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010761 timeout server 30s
10762 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
10763
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010764 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010765
10766
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010767transparent (deprecated)
10768 Enable client-side transparent proxying
10769 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010010770 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010771 Arguments : none
10772
10773 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
10774 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
10775 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
10776 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
10777 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
10778 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
10779 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
10780 appropriate server.
10781
10782 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
10783
10784 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
10785 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
10786
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010787 See also: "option transparent"
10788
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010789unique-id-format <string>
10790 Generate a unique ID for each request.
10791 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10792 yes | yes | yes | no
10793 Arguments :
10794 <string> is a log-format string.
10795
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010796 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
10797 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
10798 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
10799 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010800
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010801 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
10802 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
10803 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
10804 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
10805 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
10806 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
10807 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
10808 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010809
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010810 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
10811 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010812
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010813 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010814
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010815 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010816
10817 will generate:
10818
10819 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10820
10821 See also: "unique-id-header"
10822
10823unique-id-header <name>
10824 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
10825 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10826 yes | yes | yes | no
10827 Arguments :
10828 <name> is the name of the header.
10829
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010830 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
10831 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010832
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010833 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010834
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010835 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010836 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
10837
10838 will generate:
10839
10840 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10841
10842 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010843
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010844use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010845 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010846 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10847 no | yes | yes | no
10848 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010849 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
10850 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010851
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010852 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
10853 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010854
10855 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
10856 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
10857 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010858 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010859 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010860 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
10861 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010862
10863 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
10864 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
10865 assign the backend.
10866
10867 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
10868 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10869 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
10870 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
10871 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
10872 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
10873
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010874 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010875 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010876 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
10877 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
10878 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
10879
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010880 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
10881 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
10882 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
10883 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
10884 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
10885 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
10886 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
10887 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
10888 cannot be forced from the request.
10889
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010890 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010891 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
10892 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
10893
10894 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
10895 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010896
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010897
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010898use-server <server> if <condition>
10899use-server <server> unless <condition>
10900 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
10901 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10902 no | no | yes | yes
10903 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010904 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010905
10906 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
10907
10908 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
10909 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
10910 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
10911
10912 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
10913 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
10914 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
10915 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
10916 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
10917 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
10918 matches will assign the server.
10919
10920 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
10921 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
10922 with the next rules until one matches.
10923
10924 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
10925 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10926 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
10927 according to other persistence mechanisms.
10928
10929 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
10930 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
10931 stripped.
10932
10933 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
10934 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
10935 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
10936 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
10937
10938 Example :
10939 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
10940 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
10941 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
10942 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
10943 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
10944 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000010945 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010946 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
10947 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
10948
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010949 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010950
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010951
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100109525. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010953--------------------------
10954
10955The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
10956depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
10957settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
10958written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
10959described in this section.
10960
10961
109625.1. Bind options
10963-----------------
10964
10965The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
10966as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
10967no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
10968parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
10969while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
10970provided immediately after the setting name.
10971
10972The currently supported settings are the following ones.
10973
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010974accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
10975 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
10976 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
10977 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
10978 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
10979 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
10980 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
10981 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
10982 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
10983 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010984 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
10985 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
10986 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010987
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010988accept-proxy
10989 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020010990 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
10991 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010992 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
10993 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
10994 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
10995 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010996 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010997 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
10998 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010999 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
11000 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011001
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020011002allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010011003 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010011004 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
11005 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, ie requests
11006 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
11007 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020011008
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011009alpn <protocols>
11010 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
11011 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
11012 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
11013 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
11014 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011015 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
11016 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
11017 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
11018 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
11019 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
11020 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
11021 preference, like below :
11022
11023 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011024
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011025backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010011026 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011027 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
11028
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010011029curves <curves>
11030 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
11031 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
11032 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
11033 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
11034 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
11035 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
11036
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020011037ecdhe <named curve>
11038 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010011039 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
11040 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020011041
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011042ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011043 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11044 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11045 client's certificate.
11046
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011047ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
11048 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11049 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
11050 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
11051 error is ignored.
11052
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011053ca-sign-file <cafile>
11054 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11055 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
11056 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
11057 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
11058 'generate-certificates' for details.
11059
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000011060ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011061 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
11062 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
11063 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
11064 'generate-certificates' for details.
11065
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011066ciphers <ciphers>
11067 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
11068 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000011069 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011070 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011071 information and recommendations see e.g.
11072 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
11073 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
11074 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
11075
11076ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11077 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11078 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
11079 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
11080 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011081 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
11082 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011083
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011084crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011085 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11086 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11087 to verify client's certificate.
11088
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011089crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011090 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11091 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
11092 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
11093 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
11094 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
11095 file.
11096
11097 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
11098 are loaded.
11099
11100 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010011101 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011102 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
11103 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
11104 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
11105 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011106 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
11107 instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011108 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011109
11110 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
11111 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
11112 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
11113 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010011114 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
11115 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011116
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020011117 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011118
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011119 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011120 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011121 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
11122 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011123 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
11124 clients).
11125
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020011126 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
11127 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
11128 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
11129 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
11130 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
11131 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
11132 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
11133 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
11134 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
11135 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
11136 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
11137 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
11138 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
11139
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011140 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
11141 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
11142 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
11143 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
11144 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
11145
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011146 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
11147 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
11148 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
11149 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011150
11151 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
11152 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
11153 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
11154 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
11155 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
11156 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
11157 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
11158 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
11159 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
11160
11161 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
11162
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011163 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011164 a cert bundle.
11165
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011166 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011167 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
11168 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
11169 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
11170 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
11171 provide multi-cert support.
11172
11173 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
11174
11175 Filename | CN | SAN
11176 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11177 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011178 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011179 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
11180 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11181
11182 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
11183 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
11184 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
11185 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011186 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
11187 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
11188 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011189
11190 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
11191 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
11192
11193 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
11194 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
11195 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
11196
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011197crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011198 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011199 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011200 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011201 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011202
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011203crt-list <file>
11204 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011205 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
11206 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011207
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011208 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
11209
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011210 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "no-ca-names",
11211 crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With BoringSSL
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011212 and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported.
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011213 It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011214
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020011215 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
11216 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
11217 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
11218 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
11219 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
11220 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
11221 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
11222 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011223
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011224 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020011225 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011226 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
11227 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
11228 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011229
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011230 crt-list file example:
11231 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011232 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011233 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011234 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011235
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011236defer-accept
11237 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11238 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
11239 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011240 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011241 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
11242 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
11243 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
11244 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
11245 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
11246 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
11247 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
11248
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011249expose-fd listeners
11250 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
11251 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020011252 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
11253 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011254 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011255
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011256force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011257 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011258 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011259 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011260 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011261
11262force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011263 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011264 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011265 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011266
11267force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011268 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011269 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011270 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011271
11272force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011273 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011274 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011275 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011276
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011277force-tlsv13
11278 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
11279 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011280 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011281
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011282generate-certificates
11283 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11284 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
11285 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
11286 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
11287 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
11288 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
11289 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
11290 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
11291 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
11292 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
11293 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
11294
11295 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
11296 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011297 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011298 certificate is used many times.
11299
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011300gid <gid>
11301 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
11302 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11303 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
11304 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
11305 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11306
11307group <group>
11308 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
11309 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
11310 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
11311 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
11312 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11313
11314id <id>
11315 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
11316 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
11317 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
11318 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
11319
11320interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010011321 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
11322 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
11323 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
11324 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
11325 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
11326 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010011327 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
11328 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
11329 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
11330 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
11331 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
11332 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011333
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011334level <level>
11335 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
11336 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
11337 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011338 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011339 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
11340 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
11341 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011342 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011343 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011344 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011345 all counters).
11346
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020011347severity-output <format>
11348 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
11349 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
11350 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
11351 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
11352 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
11353 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
11354 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
11355 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
11356 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
11357 rfc5424 convention.
11358
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011359maxconn <maxconn>
11360 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
11361 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
11362 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
11363 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
11364 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
11365 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
11366 eat all memory.
11367
11368mode <mode>
11369 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
11370 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
11371 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
11372 UNIX sockets.
11373
11374mss <maxseg>
11375 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
11376 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
11377 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
11378 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
11379 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
11380 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
11381 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
11382 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
11383 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
11384 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
11385 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
11386
11387name <name>
11388 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
11389 page.
11390
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011391namespace <name>
11392 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11393 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
11394 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11395 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11396
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011397nice <nice>
11398 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
11399 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
11400 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
11401 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
11402 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
11403 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
11404 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
11405 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
11406 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
11407 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
11408 one for an RDP socket.
11409
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011410no-ca-names
11411 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11412 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
11413
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011414no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011415 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011416 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011417 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011418 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011419 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
11420 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011421
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011422no-tls-tickets
11423 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11424 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11425 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011426 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
11427 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011428
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011429no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011430 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011431 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011432 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011433 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011434 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11435 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011436
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011437no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011438 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011439 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011440 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011441 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011442 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11443 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011444
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011445no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011446 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011447 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011448 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011449 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011450 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11451 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011452
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011453no-tlsv13
11454 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11455 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
11456 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
11457 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011458 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11459 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011460
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011461npn <protocols>
11462 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11463 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11464 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11465 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011466 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011467 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11468 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
11469 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
11470 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
11471 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011472
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011473prefer-client-ciphers
11474 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
11475 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
11476 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020011477 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
11478 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
11479 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011480
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011481process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011482 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011483 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011484 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011485 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
11486 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
11487 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
11488 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011489 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011490 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
11491 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
11492 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
11493 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
11494 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011495
11496 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
11497
11498 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
11499 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
11500 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
11501 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
11502 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
11503 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
11504 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
11505 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020011506
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011507proto <name>
11508 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
11509 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
11510 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
11511 in haproxy -vv.
11512 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
11513 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080011514 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011515 h2" on the bind line.
11516
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011517ssl
11518 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011519 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011520 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
11521 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020011522 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
11523 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011524
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011525ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11526 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
11527 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11528 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11529
11530ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11531 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
11532 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11533 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11534
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010011535strict-sni
11536 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
11537 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
11538 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
11539 See the "crt" option for more information.
11540
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011541tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011542 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011543 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
11544 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011545 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011546 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
11547 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
11548 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
11549 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
11550 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
11551 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
11552 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11553
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011554tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010011555 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011556 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
11557 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
11558 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
11559 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
11560 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
11561 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
11562 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020011563 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
11564 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
11565 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011566
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011567tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
11568 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010011569 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
11570 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
11571 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
11572 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
11573 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
11574 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
11575 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
11576 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
11577 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
11578 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011579 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
11580 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
11581
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011582transparent
11583 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11584 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
11585 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
11586 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
11587 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
11588 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
11589 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
11590 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
11591 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
11592 so check for support with your vendor.
11593
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011594v4v6
11595 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11596 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
11597 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
11598 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011599 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011600
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011601v6only
11602 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11603 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
11604 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011605 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
11606 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011607
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011608uid <uid>
11609 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
11610 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11611 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
11612 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
11613 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11614
11615user <user>
11616 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
11617 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11618 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
11619 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
11620 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11621
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011622verify [none|optional|required]
11623 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
11624 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
11625 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
11626 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
11627 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011628 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
11629 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
11630 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
11631 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011632
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200116335.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010011634------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011635
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011636The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
11637which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
11638arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
11639settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
11640after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
11641Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
11642address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011643
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011644 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011645 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011646
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011647Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
11648keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
11649
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011650The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011651
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020011652addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011653 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010011654 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
11655 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
11656 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
11657 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
11658 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011659
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011660agent-check
11661 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011662 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010011663 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
11664 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
11665 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011666
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011667 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011668 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020011669 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
11670 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
11671 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011672
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011673 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
11674 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
11675 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
11676 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
11677 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020011678
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011679 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011680 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011681
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011682 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11683 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
11684 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011685
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011686 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11687 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
11688 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011689
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011690 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
11691 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
11692 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
11693 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
11694 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011695 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011696 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011697
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011698 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
11699 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011700
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011701 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
11702 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
11703 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
11704 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
11705 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
11706 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
11707 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
11708 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
11709 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011710
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011711 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
11712 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011713 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
11714 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
11715 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010011716 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011717
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011718 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011719 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011720
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070011721agent-send <string>
11722 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
11723 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
11724 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
11725 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
11726 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
11727
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011728agent-inter <delay>
11729 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
11730 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11731
11732 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
11733 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
11734 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
11735 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
11736 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11737 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11738 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11739 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11740 of backends use the same servers.
11741
11742 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
11743
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010011744agent-addr <addr>
11745 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
11746
11747 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
11748 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
11749 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
11750 hostname, it will be resolved.
11751
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011752agent-port <port>
11753 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
11754
11755 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
11756
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020011757allow-0rtt
11758 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
11759 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data.
11760
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011761alpn <protocols>
11762 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
11763 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
11764 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
11765 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
11766 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
11767 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
11768 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
11769 now obsolete NPN extension.
11770 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
11771 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
11772
11773 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
11774
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011775backup
11776 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
11777 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
11778 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
11779 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011780 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
11781 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011782
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011783ca-file <cafile>
11784 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11785 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11786 server's certificate.
11787
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011788check
11789 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010011790 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
11791 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
11792 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
11793 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
11794 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
11795 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
11796 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090011797 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
11798 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011799 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
11800 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011801
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020011802check-send-proxy
11803 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
11804 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
11805 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
11806 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
11807 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
11808 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
11809 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
11810
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010011811check-alpn <protocols>
11812 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
11813 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
11814 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11815
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011816check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011817 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011818 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
11819 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011820
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011821check-ssl
11822 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
11823 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
11824 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
11825 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011826 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011827 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
11828 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011829 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011830 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
11831 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011832
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011833ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011834 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
11835 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
11836 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011837 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
11838 information and recommendations see e.g.
11839 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
11840 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
11841 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011842
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011843ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11844 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11845 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
11846 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
11847 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011848 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
11849 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
11850 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011851
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011852cookie <value>
11853 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
11854 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
11855 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
11856 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
11857 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
11858 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
11859 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
11860
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011861crl-file <crlfile>
11862 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11863 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11864 to verify server's certificate.
11865
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020011866crt <cert>
11867 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11868 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
11869 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
11870 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
11871 certificate request.
11872
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011873disabled
11874 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
11875 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
11876 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
11877 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
11878 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011879 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011880
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011881enabled
11882 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
11883 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
11884 default value.
11885 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
11886 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011887
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011888error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010011889 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
11890 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
11891 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011892
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011893 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011894
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011895fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011896 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
11897 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
11898 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
11899
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011900force-sslv3
11901 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11902 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011903 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011904 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011905
11906force-tlsv10
11907 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011908 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011909 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011910
11911force-tlsv11
11912 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011913 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011914 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011915
11916force-tlsv12
11917 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011918 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011919 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011920
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011921force-tlsv13
11922 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11923 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011924 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011925
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011926id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020011927 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
11928 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
11929 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011930
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011931init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
11932 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
11933 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011934 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011935 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
11936 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
11937 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
11938 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
11939 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
11940 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
11941 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
11942 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
11943 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011944 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011945 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
11946 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
11947 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
11948 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
11949 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
11950 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011951 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011952
11953 Example:
11954 defaults
11955 # never fail on address resolution
11956 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
11957
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011958inter <delay>
11959fastinter <delay>
11960downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011961 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
11962 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11963 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
11964 between checks depending on the server state :
11965
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020011966 Server state | Interval used
11967 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11968 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
11969 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11970 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
11971 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
11972 or yet unchecked. |
11973 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11974 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
11975 | "inter" otherwise.
11976 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011977
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011978 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
11979 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
11980 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
11981 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011982 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11983 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11984 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11985 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11986 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011987
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011988maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011989 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
11990 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
11991 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
11992 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
11993 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
11994 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
11995 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
11996 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
11997
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011998maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011999 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
12000 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
12001 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
12002 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
12003 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
12004 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
12005 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
12006
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010012007max-reuse <count>
12008 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
12009 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
12010 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
12011 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
12012 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
12013 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
12014 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
12015 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
12016
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012017minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012018 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
12019 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
12020 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
12021 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
12022 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
12023 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012024 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012025 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012026
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020012027namespace <name>
12028 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
12029 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
12030 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
12031 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
12032
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012033no-agent-check
12034 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
12035 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12036 default value.
12037 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12038 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
12039
12040no-backup
12041 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
12042 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12043 default value.
12044 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12045 "default-server" "backup" setting.
12046
12047no-check
12048 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
12049 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12050 default value.
12051 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12052 "default-server" "check" setting.
12053
12054no-check-ssl
12055 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
12056 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12057 default value.
12058 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12059 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
12060
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012061no-send-proxy
12062 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
12063 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12064 default value.
12065 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12066 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
12067
12068no-send-proxy-v2
12069 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
12070 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12071 default value.
12072 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12073 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
12074
12075no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
12076 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
12077 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12078 default value.
12079 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12080 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
12081
12082no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12083 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
12084 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12085 default value.
12086 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12087 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
12088
12089no-ssl
12090 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
12091 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12092 default value.
12093 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12094 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
12095
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010012096no-ssl-reuse
12097 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
12098 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
12099 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
12100 and for paranoid users.
12101
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012102no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012103 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12104 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012105 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012106
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012107 Supported in default-server: No
12108
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020012109no-tls-tickets
12110 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12111 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
12112 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012113 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
12114 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012115 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020012116
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012117no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012118 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012119 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12120 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012121 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12122 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012123 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012124
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012125 Supported in default-server: No
12126
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012127no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012128 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012129 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12130 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012131 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12132 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012133 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012134
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012135 Supported in default-server: No
12136
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012137no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012138 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012139 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12140 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012141 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12142 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012143 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012144
12145 Supported in default-server: No
12146
12147no-tlsv13
12148 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12149 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12150 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
12151 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12152 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012153 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012154
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012155 Supported in default-server: No
12156
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012157no-verifyhost
12158 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
12159 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12160 default value.
12161 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12162 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012163
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090012164non-stick
12165 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
12166 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
12167 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
12168
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012169npn <protocols>
12170 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
12171 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
12172 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
12173 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
12174 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
12175 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
12176 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
12177
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012178observe <mode>
12179 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
12180 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
12181 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
12182 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
12183 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
12184 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010012185 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012186
12187 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
12188
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012189on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012190 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
12191 Currently, four modes are available:
12192 - fastinter: force fastinter
12193 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
12194 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
12195 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
12196 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
12197
12198 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
12199
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012200on-marked-down <action>
12201 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
12202 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012203 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
12204 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
12205 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
12206 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
12207 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
12208 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
12209 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
12210 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012211
12212 Actions are disabled by default
12213
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012214on-marked-up <action>
12215 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
12216 Currently one action is available:
12217 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
12218 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
12219 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
12220 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012221 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
12222 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012223 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
12224 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
12225
12226 Actions are disabled by default
12227
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010012228pool-max-conn <max>
12229 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
12230 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
12231 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
12232 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
12233 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
12234 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
12235
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012236pool-purge-delay <delay>
12237 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010012238 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
12239 The default is 1s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012240
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012241port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012242 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
12243 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
12244 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
12245 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
12246 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
12247 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
12248
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020012249proto <name>
12250
12251 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
12252 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
12253 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
12254 reported in haproxy -vv.
12255 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
12256 protocol for all connections established to this server.
12257
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012258redir <prefix>
12259 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
12260 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
12261 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
12262 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
12263 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
12264 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
12265 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
12266 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012267 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012268 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012269 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
12270 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
12271 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
12272 loop between the client and HAProxy!
12273
12274 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
12275
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012276rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012277 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
12278 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
12279 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
12280
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020012281resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
12282 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
12283 server.
12284
12285 Available options:
12286
12287 * allow-dup-ip
12288 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
12289 resolution at runtime is in operation.
12290 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
12291 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
12292 For such case, simply enable this option.
12293 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
12294
12295 * prevent-dup-ip
12296 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
12297 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
12298 same fqdn.
12299 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
12300
12301 Example:
12302 backend b_myapp
12303 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
12304 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12305 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12306
12307 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
12308 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
12309 it
12310 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
12311 different address
12312
12313 Default value: not set
12314
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012315resolve-prefer <family>
12316 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
12317 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
12318 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
12319 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
12320
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020012321 Default value: ipv6
12322
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012323 Example:
12324
12325 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012326
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012327resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
12328 This options prioritize th choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
12329 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012330 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012331 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
12332 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012333 configured network, another address is selected.
12334
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012335 Example:
12336
12337 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012338
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012339resolvers <id>
12340 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
12341 hostname.
12342
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012343 Example:
12344
12345 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012346
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012347 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012348
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012349send-proxy
12350 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
12351 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
12352 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
12353 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012354 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
12355 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
12356 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
12357 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
12358 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
12359 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
12360 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
12361 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
12362 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
12363 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012364 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
12365 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012366
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012367send-proxy-v2
12368 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
12369 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12370 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12371 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020012372 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
12373 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
12374 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
12375 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012376
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012377proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
12378 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add option to send in PROXY protocol version
12379 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are "ssl" (see also
Emmanuel Hocdetfa8d0f12018-02-01 15:53:52 +010012380 send-proxy-v2-ssl), "cert-cn" (see also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"), "ssl-cipher":
12381 name of the used cipher, "cert-sig": signature algorithm of the used
Emmanuel Hocdet253c3b72018-02-01 18:29:59 +010012382 certificate, "cert-key": key algorithm of the used certificate), "authority":
12383 host name value passed by the client (only sni from a tls connection is
Emmanuel Hocdet4399c752018-02-05 15:26:43 +010012384 supported), "crc32c": checksum of the proxy protocol v2 header.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012385
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012386send-proxy-v2-ssl
12387 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12388 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12389 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12390 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12391 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12392 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
12393 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012394 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
12395 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012396
12397send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12398 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12399 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12400 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12401 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12402 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12403 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
12404 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
12405 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012406 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
12407 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012408
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012409slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012410 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
12411 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
12412 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
12413 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
12414 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
12415 parameters :
12416
12417 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
12418 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
12419
12420 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
12421 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
12422 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
12423 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
12424
12425 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
12426 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
12427 seen as failed.
12428
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012429sni <expression>
12430 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
12431 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
12432 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
12433 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020012434 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
12435 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012436 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010012437 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
12438 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012439
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012440source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020012441source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012442source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012443 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
12444 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
12445 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
12446 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
12447
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012448 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
12449 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
12450 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
12451 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
12452 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
12453 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
12454 server.
12455
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000012456 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
12457 specifying the source address without port(s).
12458
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012459ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020012460 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
12461 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
12462 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
12463 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
12464 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
12465 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012466 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
12467 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012468
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012469ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12470 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
12471 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12472 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12473
12474ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12475 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
12476 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12477 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
12478
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012479ssl-reuse
12480 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
12481 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12482 default value.
12483 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12484 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
12485
12486stick
12487 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
12488 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12489 default value.
12490 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12491 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012492
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012493tcp-ut <delay>
12494 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
12495 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
12496 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012497 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012498 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
12499 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
12500 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
12501 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
12502 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
12503 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
12504 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
12505 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
12506 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12507
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012508track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020012509 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
12510 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
12511 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
12512 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012513 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
12514
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012515tls-tickets
12516 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
12517 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12518 default value.
12519 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12520 "default-server" "no-tlsv-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012521
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012522verify [none|required]
12523 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010012524 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012525 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
12526 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012527 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012528 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
12529 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
12530 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
12531 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
12532 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
12533 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
12534 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
12535 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012536
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012537verifyhost <hostname>
12538 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012539 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
12540 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
12541 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
12542 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
12543 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
12544 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
12545 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
12546 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012547
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012548weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012549 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
12550 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
12551 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020012552 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
12553 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
12554 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
12555 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
12556 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
12557 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012558
12559
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200125605.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
12561-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012562
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012563HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
12564using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
12565configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012566This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
12567can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
12568workload.
12569This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
12570resolution at run time.
12571Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
12572carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
12573
12574
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200125755.3.1. Global overview
12576----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012577
12578As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
12579different steps of the process life:
12580
12581 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
12582 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
12583 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
12584
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012585 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
12586 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012587
12588A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
12589 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
12590 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
12591 resolution to know this new IP.
12592
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012593When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012594HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012595SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
12596from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
12597will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
12598will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020012599
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012600A few things important to notice:
12601 - all the name servers are queried in the mean time. HAProxy will process the
12602 first valid response.
12603
12604 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
12605 servers return an error.
12606
12607
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200126085.3.2. The resolvers section
12609----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012610
12611This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012612HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
12613contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012614
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012615When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
12616uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
12617is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
12618answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
12619
12620When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012621used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012622
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012623 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
12624 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
12625 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012626
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012627 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
12628 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012629
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012630 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
12631 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
12632 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012633
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012634For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
12635following scenarios are possible:
12636
12637 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
12638 ignored
12639
12640 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
12641 applied
12642
12643 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
12644 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
12645
12646 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
12647 retries the query with a new type
12648
12649 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
12650 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012651
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012652As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
12653a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012654<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012655
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012656
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012657resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012658 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012659
12660A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
12661
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012662accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012663 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012664 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012665 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
12666 by RFC 6891)
12667
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020012668 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
12669
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012670nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
12671 DNS server description:
12672 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
12673 <ip> : IP address of the server
12674 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
12675
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012676parse-resolv-conf
12677 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
12678 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
12679 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
12680
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012681hold <status> <period>
12682 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
12683 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012684 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012685 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012686 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
12687 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12688 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
12689
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020012690 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012691
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012692resolution_pool_size <nb> (deprecated)
Baptiste Assmann201c07f2017-05-22 15:17:15 +020012693 Defines the number of resolutions available in the pool for this resolvers.
12694 If not defines, it defaults to 64. If your configuration requires more than
12695 <nb>, then HAProxy will return an error when parsing the configuration.
12696
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012697resolve_retries <nb>
12698 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
12699 giving up.
12700 Default value: 3
12701
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012702 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
12703 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
12704 type.
12705
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012706timeout <event> <time>
12707 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
12708 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
12709 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010012710 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
12711 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012712 Default value: 1s
12713 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010012714 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012715 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012716 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12717 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
12718
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012719 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012720
12721 resolvers mydns
12722 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
12723 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012724 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012725 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012726 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012727 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012728 hold other 30s
12729 hold refused 30s
12730 hold nx 30s
12731 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012732 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012733 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012734
12735
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200127366. HTTP header manipulation
12737---------------------------
12738
12739In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
12740response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
12741request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
12742which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010012743against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012744
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010012745If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
12746to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
12747but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
12748HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
12749stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
12750because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
12751a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
12752still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020012753
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012754This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
12755in section 4.2 :
12756
12757 - reqadd <string>
12758 - reqallow <search>
12759 - reqiallow <search>
12760 - reqdel <search>
12761 - reqidel <search>
12762 - reqdeny <search>
12763 - reqideny <search>
12764 - reqpass <search>
12765 - reqipass <search>
12766 - reqrep <search> <replace>
12767 - reqirep <search> <replace>
12768 - reqtarpit <search>
12769 - reqitarpit <search>
12770 - rspadd <string>
12771 - rspdel <search>
12772 - rspidel <search>
12773 - rspdeny <search>
12774 - rspideny <search>
12775 - rsprep <search> <replace>
12776 - rspirep <search> <replace>
12777
12778With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
12779is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
12780parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
12781prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
12782Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
12783
12784 \t for a tab
12785 \r for a carriage return (CR)
12786 \n for a new line (LF)
12787 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
12788 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
12789 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
12790 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
12791 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
12792
12793The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
12794portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
12795above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
12796regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
127979 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
12798is very common to users of the "sed" program.
12799
12800The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
12801after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
12802
12803Notes related to these keywords :
12804---------------------------------
12805 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
12806 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
12807 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
12808
12809 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
12810 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
12811 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
12812
12813 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
12814 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
12815 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
12816 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
12817 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
12818
12819 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
12820 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
12821 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
12822 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
12823 useless headers before adding new ones.
12824
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012825 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012826 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
12827
12828 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
12829 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
12830 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
12831
12832 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
12833 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012834 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012835
12836
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200128377. Using ACLs and fetching samples
12838----------------------------------
12839
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012840HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012841client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
12842The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
12843these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
12844but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
12845data called patterns.
12846
12847
128487.1. ACL basics
12849---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012850
12851The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
12852content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
12853from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
12854simple :
12855
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012856 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012857 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012858 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
12859 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012860
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012861The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
12862adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012863
12864In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
12865
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012866 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012867
12868This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
12869Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
12870and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012871an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
12872conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
12873as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
12874are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012875
12876ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
12877'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
12878which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
12879
12880There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
12881performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
12882
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012883The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
12884specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
12885this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012886methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
12887ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012888
12889Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
12890 - boolean
12891 - integer (signed or unsigned)
12892 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
12893 - string
12894 - data block
12895
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012896Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
12897converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
12898would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
12899The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
12900which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
12901
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012902Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
12903keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
12904fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
12905which are summarized in the table below :
12906
12907 +---------------------+-----------------+
12908 | Sample or converter | Default |
12909 | output type | matching method |
12910 +---------------------+-----------------+
12911 | boolean | bool |
12912 +---------------------+-----------------+
12913 | integer | int |
12914 +---------------------+-----------------+
12915 | ip | ip |
12916 +---------------------+-----------------+
12917 | string | str |
12918 +---------------------+-----------------+
12919 | binary | none, use "-m" |
12920 +---------------------+-----------------+
12921
12922Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
12923matching method, see below.
12924
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012925The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
12926 - boolean
12927 - integer or integer range
12928 - IP address / network
12929 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
12930 - regular expression
12931 - hex block
12932
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012933The following ACL flags are currently supported :
12934
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012935 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
12936 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012937 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012938 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012939 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012940 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012941 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
12942
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012943The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
12944read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
12945if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
12946lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
12947will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
12948beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
12949a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
12950lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
12951exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
12952
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012953The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
12954parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
12955ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
12956a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
12957check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
12958
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012959The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
12960socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
12961file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
12962
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012963Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
12964loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
12965
12966 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
12967
12968In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
12969the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
12970case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
12971as well.
12972
12973The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
12974sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
12975do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
12976methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
12977is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012978obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012979followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
12980default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
12981that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
12982string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
12983
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012984The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
12985By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
12986string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
12987resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
12988server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
12989waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
12990flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
12991function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
12992
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012993There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
12994sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
12995be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012996
12997 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
12998 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012999 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
13000 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
13001 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
13002 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013003
13004 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
13005 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013006 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013007
13008 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013009 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013010
13011 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013012 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013013
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013014 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013015 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
13016
13017 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
13018 binary or string samples.
13019
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013020 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
13021 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013022
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013023 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
13024 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
13025 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013026
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013027 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
13028 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013029
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013030 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
13031 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013032
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013033 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
13034 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013035
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013036 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
13037 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013038 This may be used with binary or string samples.
13039
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013040 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
13041 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
13042 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013043
13044For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
13045request, it is possible to do :
13046
13047 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
13048
13049In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
13050buffer, one would use the following acl :
13051
13052 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
13053
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013054On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
13055possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
13056
13057 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
13058
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013059All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
13060criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
13061method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
13062to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
13063criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
13064the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013065
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013066If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013067the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
13068For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013069
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013070 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
13071 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
13072 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
13073 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013074
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013075
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013076The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
13077types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
13078combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
13079brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
13080default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013081
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013082 +-------------------------------------------------+
13083 | Input sample type |
13084 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013085 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013086 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
13087 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
13088 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013089 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013090 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013091 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013092 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013093 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013094 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013095 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013096 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013097 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013098 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013099 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013100 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013101 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013102 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013103 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013104 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013105 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013106 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013107 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013108 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013109 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013110 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
13111 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
13112 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013113
13114
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200131157.1.1. Matching booleans
13116------------------------
13117
13118In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
13119Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
13120When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
13121that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
13122
13123Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
13124return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
13125"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
13126
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013127
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200131287.1.2. Matching integers
13129------------------------
13130
13131Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
13132enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
13133to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
13134
13135Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
13136matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
13137lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013138
13139For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
13140unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
13141representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
13142
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013143As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
13144two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
13145instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
13146ranges and operators.
13147
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013148For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013149operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
13150Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
13151of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013152
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013153Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013154
13155 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
13156 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
13157 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
13158 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
13159 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
13160
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013161For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013162
13163 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
13164
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013165This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
13166
13167 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
13168
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013169
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200131707.1.3. Matching strings
13171-----------------------
13172
13173String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
13174different forms :
13175
13176 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013177 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013178
13179 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013180 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013181
13182 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
13183 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13184
13185 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
13186 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13187
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010013188 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013189 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
13190 matches.
13191
13192 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
13193 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
13194 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013195
13196String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
13197exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
13198characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
13199string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
13200to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013201before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013202
13203
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200132047.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
13205---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013206
13207Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
13208they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
13209possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
13210passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
13211the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013212the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
13213match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013214
13215
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200132167.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
13217-------------------------------------
13218
13219It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
13220not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
13221a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
13222to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
13223digits may be used upper or lower case.
13224
13225Example :
13226 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
13227 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
13228
13229
132307.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
13231---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013232
13233IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
13234netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
13235within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013236host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013237difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
13238at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
13239does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
13240parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013241
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020013242The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
13243abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
13244
13245 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13246 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
13247 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13248 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
13249 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
13250 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
13251 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
13252 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13253
13254Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
13255192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
13256
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013257IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
13258Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
13259trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
13260IPv6 patterns.
13261
13262HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
13263following situations :
13264 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
13265 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
13266 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
13267 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
13268 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
13269 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
13270 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
13271 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
13272 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
13273 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
13274
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013275
132767.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
13277----------------------------------
13278
13279Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
13280combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
13281
13282 - AND (implicit)
13283 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
13284 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013285
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013286A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013287
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013288 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013289
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013290Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
13291indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013292
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013293For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
13294"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
13295requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
13296is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
13297
13298 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013299 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
13300 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
13301 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013302
13303To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
13304and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
13305
13306 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
13307 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
13308 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
13309 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
13310
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013311 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013312 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
13313 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
13314 use_backend www if host_www
13315
13316It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
13317expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
13318be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
13319the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
13320
13321 The following rule :
13322
13323 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013324 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013325
13326 Can also be written that way :
13327
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013328 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013329
13330It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
13331to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
13332simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
13333sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
13334good use is the following :
13335
13336 With named ACLs :
13337
13338 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
13339 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
13340 monitor fail if site_dead
13341
13342 With anonymous ACLs :
13343
13344 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
13345
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013346See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
13347keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013348
13349
133507.3. Fetching samples
13351---------------------
13352
13353Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
13354against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
13355sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
13356ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
13357of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
13358available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
13359
13360This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
13361Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
13362compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
13363deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
13364
13365The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
13366matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
13367method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
13368indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
13369
13370As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
13371when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
13372mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
13373the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
13374ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
13375
13376Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
13377multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
13378when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013379incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
13380are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013381is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
13382all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
13383
13384Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
13385 - name
13386 - name(arg1)
13387 - name(arg1,arg2)
13388
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013389
133907.3.1. Converters
13391-----------------
13392
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013393Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
13394of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
13395is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
13396was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013397has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013398unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
13399
13400These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
13401sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
13402the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013403support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013404
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013405A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
13406support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
13407supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
13408(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
13409bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
13410
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013411The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013412
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001341351d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
13414 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
13415 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
13416 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
13417 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
13418 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
13419
13420 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013421 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
13422 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000013423 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
13424 frontend http-in
13425 bind *:8081
13426 default_backend servers
13427 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
13428 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
13429
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013430add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013431 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013432 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013433 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
13434 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013435 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013436 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13437 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13438 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13439 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013440 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013441 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013442
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010013443aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
13444 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
13445 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
13446 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
13447 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
13448 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
13449 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
13450
13451 Example:
13452 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
13453 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
13454
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013455and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013456 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013457 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013458 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13459 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013460 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013461 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13462 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13463 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13464 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013465 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013466 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013467
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020013468b64dec
13469 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
13470 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
13471
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013472base64
13473 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013474 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013475 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
13476
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013477bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013478 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013479 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013480 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013481 presence of a flag).
13482
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013483bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
13484 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
13485 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013486 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013487
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013488concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
13489 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
13490 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
13491 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
13492 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
13493 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
13494 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
13495 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
13496 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
13497 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
13498 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
13499 other variables, such as colon-delimited varlues. Note that due to the config
13500 parser, it is not possible to use a comma nor a closing parenthesis as
13501 delimitors.
13502
13503 Example:
13504 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
13505 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
13506 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
13507 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
13508
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013509cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013510 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
13511 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013512
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013513crc32([<avalanche>])
13514 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
13515 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13516 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13517 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13518 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13519 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
13520 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
13521 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
13522 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
13523 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013524 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
13525
13526crc32c([<avalanche>])
13527 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
13528 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13529 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13530 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
13531 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
13532 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
13533 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
13534 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013535
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010013536da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013537 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
13538 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
13539 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
13540 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013541 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013542 configuration language.
13543
13544 Example:
13545 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020013546 bind *:8881
13547 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013548 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013549
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020013550debug
13551 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
13552 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
13553 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
13554
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013555div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013556 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13557 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013558 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013559 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
13560 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013561 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013562 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13563 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13564 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13565 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013566 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013567 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013568
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013569djb2([<avalanche>])
13570 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
13571 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13572 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13573 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13574 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13575 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13576 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013577 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
13578 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013579
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013580even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013581 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013582 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
13583
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020013584field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
13585 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
13586 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
13587 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
13588 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
13589 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
13590 fields.
13591
13592 Example :
13593 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
13594 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
13595 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
13596 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
13597 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010013598
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013599hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013600 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013601 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013602 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013603 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010013604
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013605hex2i
13606 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
13607 integer. If the input value can not be converted, then zero is returned.
13608
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013609http_date([<offset>])
13610 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13611 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
13612 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
13613 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
13614 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
13615 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013616
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013617in_table(<table>)
13618 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13619 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
13620 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013621 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013622 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
13623
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013624ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
13625 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013626 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013627 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
13628 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
13629 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
13630 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
13631 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013632
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013633json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013634 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013635 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013636 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013637 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
13638 of errors:
13639 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
13640 bytes, ...)
13641 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
13642 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
13643
13644 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
13645 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
13646 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
13647 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
13648 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
13649 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013650 - "ascii" : never fails;
13651 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
13652 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013653 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013654 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013655 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
13656 characters corresponding to the other errors.
13657
13658 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013659 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013660
13661 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013662 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013663 capture request header user-agent len 150
13664 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013665
13666 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
13667 GET / HTTP/1.0
13668 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
13669
13670 Output log:
13671 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
13672
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013673language(<value>[,<default>])
13674 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
13675 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
13676 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
13677 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
13678 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
13679 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
13680 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
13681 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
13682 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013683 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013684 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
13685 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013686
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013687 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013688
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013689 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
13690 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013691
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013692 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
13693 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
13694 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
13695 use_backend spanish if es
13696 use_backend french if fr
13697 use_backend english if en
13698 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013699
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010013700length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010013701 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
13702 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13703 type. The result is of type integer.
13704
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013705lower
13706 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
13707 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13708 type. The result is of type string.
13709
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013710ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
13711 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13712 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
13713 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13714 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13715 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13716 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
13717
13718 Example :
13719
13720 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013721 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013722 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13723
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013724map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13725map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13726map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13727 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
13728 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
13729 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
13730 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
13731 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
13732 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
13733 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
13734 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013735
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013736 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
13737 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
13738 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013739
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013740 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013741 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013742
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013743 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
13744 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13745 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
13746 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020013747 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
13748 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013749 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
13750 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13751 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
13752 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13753 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
13754 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13755 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
13756 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080013757 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
13758 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13759 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013760 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13761 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
13762 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13763 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
13764 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013765
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010013766 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
13767 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
13768 the corresponding match text.
13769
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013770 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
13771 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
13772 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
13773 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
13774 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013775
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013776 Example :
13777
13778 # this is a comment and is ignored
13779 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
13780 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
13781 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
13782 | | | `---------- value
13783 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
13784 | `---------------------------- key
13785 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
13786
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013787mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013788 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13789 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013790 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013791 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013792 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013793 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13794 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13795 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13796 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013797 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013798 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013799
13800mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013801 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020013802 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
13803 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013804 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013805 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013806 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013807 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13808 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13809 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13810 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013811 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013812 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013813
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010013814nbsrv
13815 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
13816 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
13817 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
13818 map lookup.
13819
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013820neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013821 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
13822 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
13823 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
13824 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013825
13826not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013827 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013828 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013829 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013830 absence of a flag).
13831
13832odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013833 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013834 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
13835
13836or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013837 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013838 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013839 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13840 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013841 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013842 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13843 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13844 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13845 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013846 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013847 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013848
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010013849protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
13850 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
13851 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
13852 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
13853 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
13854 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
13855 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
13856 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
13857 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
13858 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
13859 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
13860 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
13861
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010013862regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013863 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
13864 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
13865 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
13866 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
13867 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
13868 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
13869 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
13870 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
13871 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
13872 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010013873 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
13874 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
13875 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
13876 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013877
13878 Example :
13879
13880 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
13881 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
13882 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
13883 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
13884
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013885capture-req(<id>)
13886 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
13887 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13888
13889 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013890 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13891 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013892
13893capture-res(<id>)
13894 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
13895 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13896
13897 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013898 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13899 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013900
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013901sdbm([<avalanche>])
13902 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
13903 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13904 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13905 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13906 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13907 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13908 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013909 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
13910 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013911
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013912set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013913 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
13914 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
13915 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013916 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013917 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13918 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013919 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013920 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13921 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013922 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013923 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013924
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020013925sha1
13926 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA1 digest. The result is a binary
13927 sample with length of 20 bytes.
13928
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020013929strcmp(<var>)
13930 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
13931 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
13932 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
13933 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
13934 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
13935 shorter).
13936
13937 Example :
13938
13939 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
13940 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
13941 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
13942
13943
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013944sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013945 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
13946 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013947 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013948 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
13949 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013950 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013951 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13952 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013953 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013954 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13955 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013956 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013957 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013958
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013959table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
13960 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13961 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13962 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
13963 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13964 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13965 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
13966
13967
13968table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
13969 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13970 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13971 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
13972 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13973 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13974 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
13975
13976table_conn_cnt(<table>)
13977 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13978 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013979 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013980 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
13981 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13982
13983table_conn_cur(<table>)
13984 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13985 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13986 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13987 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13988 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
13989
13990table_conn_rate(<table>)
13991 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13992 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13993 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
13994 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13995 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
13996
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013997table_gpt0(<table>)
13998 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13999 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
14000 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
14001 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
14002 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
14003
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014004table_gpc0(<table>)
14005 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14006 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14007 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
14008 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
14009 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
14010
14011table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
14012 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14013 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14014 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
14015 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
14016 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
14017 sample fetch keyword.
14018
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014019table_gpc1(<table>)
14020 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14021 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14022 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
14023 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
14024 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
14025
14026table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
14027 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14028 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14029 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
14030 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
14031 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
14032 sample fetch keyword.
14033
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014034table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
14035 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14036 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014037 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014038 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
14039 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14040
14041table_http_err_rate(<table>)
14042 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14043 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14044 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
14045 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
14046 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
14047 keyword.
14048
14049table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
14050 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14051 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014052 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014053 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
14054 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14055
14056table_http_req_rate(<table>)
14057 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14058 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14059 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
14060 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
14061 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
14062 keyword.
14063
14064table_kbytes_in(<table>)
14065 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14066 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014067 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014068 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
14069 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
14070 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
14071 keyword.
14072
14073table_kbytes_out(<table>)
14074 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14075 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014076 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014077 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
14078 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
14079 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
14080 keyword.
14081
14082table_server_id(<table>)
14083 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14084 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14085 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
14086 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
14087 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
14088 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
14089
14090table_sess_cnt(<table>)
14091 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14092 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014093 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014094 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
14095 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
14096 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
14097 keyword.
14098
14099table_sess_rate(<table>)
14100 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14101 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14102 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
14103 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
14104 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
14105 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
14106 keyword.
14107
14108table_trackers(<table>)
14109 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14110 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14111 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
14112 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
14113 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
14114 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
14115 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
14116 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
14117 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
14118 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
14119
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014120upper
14121 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
14122 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14123 type. The result is of type string.
14124
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020014125url_dec
14126 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
14127 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
14128
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014129ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014130 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014131 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
14132 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
14133 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014134 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
14135 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
14136 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
14137 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014138 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014139 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
14140 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014141
14142 Example:
14143 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
14144 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
14145
14146 message Point {
14147 int32 latitude = 1;
14148 int32 longitude = 2;
14149 }
14150
14151 message PPoint {
14152 Point point = 59;
14153 }
14154
14155 message Rectangle {
14156 // One corner of the rectangle.
14157 PPoint lo = 48;
14158 // The other corner of the rectangle.
14159 PPoint hi = 49;
14160 }
14161
14162 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
14163 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
14164 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
14165
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014166 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14167 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14168 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latidude" of "hi" second PPoint
14169 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
14170
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014171 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014172
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014173 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014174
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014175 As a gRPC message is alway made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
14176 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14177 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
14178
14179 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
14180 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
14181 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
14182
14183 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
14184 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
14185 interpret the previous binary sample.
14186
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014187
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010014188unset-var(<var name>)
14189 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
14190 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
14191 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
14192 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14193 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
14194 response),
14195 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14196 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
14197 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
14198 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
14199
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014200utime(<format>[,<offset>])
14201 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14202 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
14203 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
14204 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
14205 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
14206 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
14207
14208 Example :
14209
14210 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014211 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014212 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
14213
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014214word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
14215 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
14216 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
14217 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
14218 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
14219 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
14220
14221 Example :
14222 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
14223 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
14224 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
14225 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
14226 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010014227
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014228wt6([<avalanche>])
14229 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
14230 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14231 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14232 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14233 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14234 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14235 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014236 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
14237 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014238
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014239xor(<value>)
14240 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014241 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014242 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014243 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014244 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014245 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14246 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014247 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014248 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14249 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014250 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014251 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014252
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010014253xxh32([<seed>])
14254 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
14255 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14256 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14257 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14258 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14259 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14260 as cryptographically secure.
14261
14262xxh64([<seed>])
14263 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
14264 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14265 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14266 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14267 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14268 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14269 as cryptographically secure.
14270
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014271
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200142727.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014273--------------------------------------------
14274
14275A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
14276not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
14277"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
14278The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
14279
14280always_false : boolean
14281 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14282 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14283
14284always_true : boolean
14285 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14286 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14287
14288avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014289 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014290 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
14291 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
14292 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
14293 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
14294 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
14295 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
14296 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
14297 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
14298 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
14299 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
14300 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
14301 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
14302 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010014303
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014304be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014305 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
14306 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
14307 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
14308 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014309 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
14310
14311be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
14312 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14313 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
14314 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
14315 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
14316 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014317 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
14318 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014319
14320 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
14321 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
14322 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014323
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014324be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
14325 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14326 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14327 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014328 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014329 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
14330 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014331
14332 Example :
14333 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
14334 backend dynamic
14335 mode http
14336 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
14337 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014338
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014339bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014340 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
14341 of the string.
14342
14343bool(<bool>) : bool
14344 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
14345 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
14346
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014347connslots([<backend>]) : integer
14348 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014349 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014350 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
14351 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050014352
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014353 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014354 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014355 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
14356
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014357 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
14358 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014359
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014360 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014361 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014362 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014363 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014364 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014365 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014366 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014367
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014368 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
14369 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014370 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014371 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014372
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014373cpu_calls : integer
14374 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
14375 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
14376 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
14377 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
14378 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
14379 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
14380
14381cpu_ns_avg : integer
14382 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14383 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14384 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14385 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14386 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14387 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14388 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
14389 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
14390 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
14391 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
14392 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14393
14394cpu_ns_tot : integer
14395 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14396 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14397 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14398 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14399 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14400 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14401 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
14402 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
14403 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
14404 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
14405 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
14406 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
14407 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
14408
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014409date([<offset>]) : integer
14410 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
14411 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
14412 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
14413 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014414 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
14415
14416 Example :
14417
14418 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
14419 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014420
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010014421date_us : integer
14422 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
14423 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
14424 from the same timeval structure.
14425
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020014426distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
14427 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
14428 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
14429 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
14430 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
14431 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
14432 list of supported tokens.
14433
14434distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
14435 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
14436 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
14437 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
14438 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
14439 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
14440 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
14441 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
14442 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
14443 supported tokens.
14444
14445 Example :
14446 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
14447 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
14448 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
14449 # send large files to the big farm
14450 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
14451
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020014452env(<name>) : string
14453 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
14454 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
14455 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
14456 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
14457 certain way.
14458
14459 Examples :
14460 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
14461 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
14462
14463 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
14464 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
14465
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014466fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
14467 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014468 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
14469 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014470 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
14471 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014472 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014473 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
14474 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014475
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020014476fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14477 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
14478 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
14479 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
14480
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014481fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14482 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14483 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14484 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
14485 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
14486 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
14487 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
14488 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
14489 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014490
14491 Example :
14492 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
14493 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
14494 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
14495 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
14496 frontend mail
14497 bind :25
14498 mode tcp
14499 maxconn 100
14500 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
14501 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
14502 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
14503 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014504
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010014505hostname : string
14506 Returns the system hostname.
14507
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014508int(<integer>) : signed integer
14509 Returns a signed integer.
14510
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014511ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
14512 Returns an ipv4.
14513
14514ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
14515 Returns an ipv6.
14516
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014517lat_ns_avg : integer
14518 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14519 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14520 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14521 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14522 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14523 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14524 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14525 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14526 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14527 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14528 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14529 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14530 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex.
14531 Note: this value is exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14532
14533lat_ns_tot : integer
14534 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14535 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14536 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14537 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14538 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14539 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14540 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14541 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14542 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14543 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14544 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14545 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14546 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
14547 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
14548 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
14549 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
14550 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
14551 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
14552 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
14553
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014554meth(<method>) : method
14555 Returns a method.
14556
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014557nbproc : integer
14558 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
14559 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
14560 and debugging purposes.
14561
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014562nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
14563 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
14564 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
14565 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014566 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
14567 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
14568 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014569
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040014570prio_class : integer
14571 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
14572 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
14573 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
14574
14575prio_offset : integer
14576 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
14577 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
14578 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
14579 set-priority-offset".
14580
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014581proc : integer
14582 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
14583 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
14584 debugging purposes.
14585
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014586queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014587 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
14588 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
14589 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014590 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
14591 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
14592 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
14593 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
14594 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
14595
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010014596rand([<range>]) : integer
14597 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
14598 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
14599 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
14600 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
14601 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
14602
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014603srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14604 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14605 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
14606 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
14607 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
14608 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014609 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
14610 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
14611
14612srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14613 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14614 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
14615 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14616 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
14617 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
14618 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
14619 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
14620
14621 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
14622 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014623
14624srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
14625 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
14626 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
14627 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014628 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014629 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
14630 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
14631 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
14632
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020014633srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14634 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
14635 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14636 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
14637 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
14638 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
14639 fetch methods.
14640
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014641srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14642 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14643 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014644 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014645 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
14646 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014647 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014648 overloading servers).
14649
14650 Example :
14651 # Redirect to a separate back
14652 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
14653 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
14654 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
14655
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014656stopping : boolean
14657 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
14658 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
14659 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
14660
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014661str(<string>) : string
14662 Returns a string.
14663
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014664table_avl([<table>]) : integer
14665 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
14666 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
14667
14668table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14669 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
14670 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
14671 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
14672
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010014673thread : integer
14674 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
14675 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
14676 and debugging purposes.
14677
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014678var(<var-name>) : undefined
14679 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014680 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
14681 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014682 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014683 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14684 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014685 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014686 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14687 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014688 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014689 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014690
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200146917.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014692----------------------------------
14693
14694The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
14695closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
14696methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
14697sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
14698TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014699the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
14700counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020014701"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
14702used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
14703can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
14704Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
14705table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
14706tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
14707currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014708
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010014709bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010014710 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14711 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14712 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
14713
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014714be_id : integer
14715 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
14716 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14717
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014718be_name : string
14719 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
14720 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14721
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014722dst : ip
14723 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
14724 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
14725 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
14726 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010014727 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
14728 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
14729 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
14730 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
14731 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
14732 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014733
14734dst_conn : integer
14735 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14736 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
14737 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
14738 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
14739 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
14740 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
14741 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
14742 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014743
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014744dst_is_local : boolean
14745 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
14746 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
14747 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
14748 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014749 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014750 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
14751 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
14752 it only once per connection.
14753
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014754dst_port : integer
14755 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
14756 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
14757 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
14758 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
14759 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
14760 an HTTP header.
14761
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020014762fc_http_major : integer
14763 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14764 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14765 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
14766
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010014767fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
14768 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
14769 header.
14770
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020014771fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
14772 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
14773 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
14774 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
14775 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14776 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14777 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14778
14779fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
14780 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
14781 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
14782 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
14783 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14784 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14785 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14786
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014787fc_unacked(<unit>) : integer
14788 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14789 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14790 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14791 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14792
14793fc_sacked(<unit>) : integer
14794 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14795 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14796 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14797 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14798
14799fc_retrans(<unit>) : integer
14800 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
14801 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14802 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14803 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14804
14805fc_fackets(<unit>) : integer
14806 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
14807 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14808 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14809 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14810
14811fc_lost(<unit>) : integer
14812 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
14813 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14814 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14815 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14816
14817fc_reordering(<unit>) : integer
14818 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
14819 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14820 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14821 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14822
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020014823fe_defbe : string
14824 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
14825 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
14826
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014827fe_id : integer
14828 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010014829 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014830 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14831
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014832fe_name : string
14833 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
14834 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
14835 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14836
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014837sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014838sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14839sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14840sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014841 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
14842 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14843 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
14844
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014845sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014846sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14847sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14848sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014849 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
14850 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14851 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
14852
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014853sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014854sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14855sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14856sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014857 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14858 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014859 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14860 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14861 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014862
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014863 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014864 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
14865 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014866 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
14867 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
14868 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014869 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
14870 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14871
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014872sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14873sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14874sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14875sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14876 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14877 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
14878 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14879 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14880 when a first ACL was verified.
14881
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014882sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014883sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14884sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14885sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014886 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014887 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
14888
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014889sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014890sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14891sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14892sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014893 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
14894 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
14895 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
14896
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014897sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014898sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14899sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14900sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014901 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
14902 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
14903 See also src_conn_rate.
14904
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014905sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014906sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14907sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14908sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014909 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014910 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014911
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014912sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14913sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14914sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14915sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14916 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
14917 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
14918
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014919sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14920sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14921sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14922sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14923 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
14924 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
14925
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014926sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014927sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14928sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14929sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014930 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
14931 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14932 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014933 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
14934 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14935 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014936
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014937sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14938sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14939sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14940sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14941 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
14942 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14943 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
14944 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
14945 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14946 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
14947
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014948sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014949sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14950sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14951sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014952 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014953 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
14954 See also src_http_err_cnt.
14955
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014956sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014957sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14958sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14959sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014960 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
14961 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
14962 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
14963 src_http_err_rate.
14964
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014965sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014966sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14967sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14968sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014969 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014970 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
14971 src_http_req_cnt.
14972
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014973sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014974sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14975sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14976sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014977 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
14978 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
14979 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
14980 src_http_req_rate.
14981
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014982sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014983sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14984sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14985sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014986 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014987 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
14988 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
14989 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
14990 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014991
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014992 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014993 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
14994 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014995 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14996
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014997sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14998sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14999sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15000sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15001 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
15002 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
15003 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
15004 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
15005 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
15006
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015007sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015008sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
15009sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
15010sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015011 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
15012 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
15013 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015014
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015015sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015016sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
15017sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
15018sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015019 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
15020 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
15021 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015022
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015023sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015024sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15025sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15026sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015027 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015028 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
15029 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
15030 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015031 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015032 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
15033
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015034sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015035sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15036sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15037sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015038 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
15039 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15040 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
15041 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
15042 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015043 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015044
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015045sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015046sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
15047sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
15048sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020015049 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
15050 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
15051 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
15052
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015053sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015054sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
15055sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
15056sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015057 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
15058 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015059 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015060 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
15061 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015062 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
15063 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
15064 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015065
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015066so_id : integer
15067 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
15068 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
15069 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015070
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015071src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015072 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015073 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
15074 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
15075 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015076 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
15077 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
15078 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010015079 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
15080 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
15081 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
15082 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
15083 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
15084 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
15085 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015086
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015087 Example:
15088 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
15089 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
15090
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015091src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15092 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
15093 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
15094 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015095 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015096
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015097src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15098 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
15099 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015100 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015101 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015102
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015103src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15104 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15105 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15106 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
15107 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
15108 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
15109 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015110
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015111 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015112 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
15113 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
15114 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
15115 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015116 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015117 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
15118 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15119
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015120src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15121 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15122 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15123 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
15124 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
15125 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
15126 was verified.
15127
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015128src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015129 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015130 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015131 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015132 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015133
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015134src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015135 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015136 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
15137 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015138 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015139
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015140src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15141 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
15142 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15143 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015144 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015145
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015146src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015147 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015148 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015149 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015150 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015151
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015152src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15153 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
15154 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
15155 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
15156 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
15157
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015158src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15159 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
15160 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
15161 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
15162 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
15163
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015164src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015165 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015166 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015167 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
15168 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015169 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
15170 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15171 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015172
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015173src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15174 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
15175 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
15176 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
15177 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
15178 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
15179 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15180 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
15181
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015182src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015183 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015184 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015185 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015186 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015187 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015188
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015189src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15190 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
15191 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15192 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
15193 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015194 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015195
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015196src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015197 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015198 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15199 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015200 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015201
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015202src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15203 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
15204 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15205 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015206 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015207 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015208
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015209src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15210 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15211 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15212 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015213 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015214 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15215 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015216
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015217 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015218 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015219 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015220 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015221
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015222src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15223 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15224 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15225 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
15226 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
15227 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15228 connection when a first ACL was verified.
15229
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015230src_is_local : boolean
15231 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
15232 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
15233 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
15234 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015235 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015236 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
15237 once per connection.
15238
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015239src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015240 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
15241 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
15242 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
15243 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
15244 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015245
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015246src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015247 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
15248 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15249 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
15250 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
15251 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015252
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015253src_port : integer
15254 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
15255 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
15256 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
15257 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015258
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015259src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015260 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015261 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15262 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
15263 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015264 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015265
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015266src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15267 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
15268 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15269 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15270 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015271 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015272
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015273src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15274 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
15275 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
15276 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
15277 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
15278 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
15279 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
15280 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
15281 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015282
15283 Example :
15284 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
15285 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
15286 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
15287 listen ssh
15288 bind :22
15289 mode tcp
15290 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015291 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015292 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015293 server local 127.0.0.1:22
15294
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015295srv_id : integer
15296 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
15297 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
15298 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020015299
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200153007.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015301----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020015302
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015303The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
15304closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
15305when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
15306usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015307future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015308
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001530951d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
15310 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15311 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15312 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
15313 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15314 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15315
15316 Example :
15317 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
15318 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
15319 # the request.
15320 frontend http-in
15321 bind *:8081
15322 default_backend servers
15323 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15324 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15325
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015326ssl_bc : boolean
15327 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15328 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
15329 other a server with the "ssl" option.
15330
15331ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
15332 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
15333 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15334
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015335ssl_bc_alpn : string
15336 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
15337 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
15338 The result is a string containing the protocol name negociated with the
15339 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15340 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15341 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
15342 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
15343 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15344 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn".
15345
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015346ssl_bc_cipher : string
15347 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
15348 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15349
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010015350ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
15351 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15352 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
15353 session or a TLS ticket.
15354
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015355ssl_bc_npn : string
15356 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
15357 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
15358 protocol name negociated with the server . The SSL library must have been
15359 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
15360 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
15361 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
15362 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
15363 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
15364
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015365ssl_bc_protocol : string
15366 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
15367 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15368
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015369ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015370 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015371 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15372 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015373
15374ssl_bc_session_id : binary
15375 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
15376 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
15377 if session was reused or not.
15378
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015379ssl_bc_session_key : binary
15380 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
15381 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15382 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15383 BoringSSL.
15384
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015385ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
15386 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
15387 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15388
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015389ssl_c_ca_err : integer
15390 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15391 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
15392 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
15393 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
15394 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015395
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015396ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
15397 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15398 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
15399 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
15400 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015401
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015402ssl_c_der : binary
15403 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
15404 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15405 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15406
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015407ssl_c_err : integer
15408 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15409 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
15410 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
15411 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
15412 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015413
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015414ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15415 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15416 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15417 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15418 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15419 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15420 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15421 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15422 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015423
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015424ssl_c_key_alg : string
15425 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15426 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15427 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015428
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015429ssl_c_notafter : string
15430 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
15431 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15432 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020015433
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015434ssl_c_notbefore : string
15435 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
15436 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15437 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015438
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015439ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15440 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15441 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15442 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15443 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15444 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15445 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15446 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15447 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015448
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015449ssl_c_serial : binary
15450 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
15451 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15452 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015453
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015454ssl_c_sha1 : binary
15455 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
15456 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
15457 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015458 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
15459 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
15460
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015461 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015462 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015463
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015464ssl_c_sig_alg : string
15465 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15466 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15467 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015468
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015469ssl_c_used : boolean
15470 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
15471 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015472
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015473ssl_c_verify : integer
15474 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
15475 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
15476 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
15477 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015478
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015479ssl_c_version : integer
15480 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
15481 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015482
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015483ssl_f_der : binary
15484 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
15485 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15486 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15487
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015488ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15489 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15490 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15491 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15492 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015493 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015494 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15495 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15496 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015497
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015498ssl_f_key_alg : string
15499 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15500 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
15501 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015502
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015503ssl_f_notafter : string
15504 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15505 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15506 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015507
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015508ssl_f_notbefore : string
15509 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15510 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15511 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015512
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015513ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15514 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15515 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15516 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15517 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15518 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15519 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15520 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15521 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015522
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015523ssl_f_serial : binary
15524 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15525 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15526 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015527
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020015528ssl_f_sha1 : binary
15529 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
15530 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
15531 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
15532
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015533ssl_f_sig_alg : string
15534 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15535 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15536 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015537
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015538ssl_f_version : integer
15539 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15540 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15541
15542ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015543 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15544 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
15545 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
15546
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015547 Example :
15548 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
15549 listen http-https
15550 bind :80
15551 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
15552 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
15553
15554ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
15555 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
15556 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15557
15558ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015559 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015560 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
15561 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
15562 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15563 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15564 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
15565 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
15566 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15567 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
15568
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015569ssl_fc_cipher : string
15570 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
15571 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020015572
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015573ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
15574 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
15575 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015576 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015577
15578ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
15579 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
15580 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015581 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015582
15583ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
15584 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
15585 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
15586 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015587 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020015588 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015589
15590ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
15591 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
15592 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015593 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015594
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015595ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015596 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
15597 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010015598 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
15599 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
15600 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
15601 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015602
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020015603ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
15604 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
15605 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
15606 wait until the handshake happened.
15607
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015608ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
15609 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020015610 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
15611 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
15612 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
15613 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015614
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020015615ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015616 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010015617 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
15618 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015619
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015620ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015621 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015622 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
15623 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
15624 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
15625 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
15626 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
15627 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
15628 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020015629
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015630ssl_fc_protocol : string
15631 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
15632 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015633
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015634ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015635 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015636 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15637 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015638
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015639ssl_fc_session_id : binary
15640 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
15641 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
15642 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
15643 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015644
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015645ssl_fc_session_key : binary
15646 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
15647 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15648 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15649 BoringSSL.
15650
15651
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015652ssl_fc_sni : string
15653 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
15654 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
15655 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
15656 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
15657 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
15658
15659 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
15660 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
15661 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020015662 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
15663 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015664
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015665 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015666 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
15667 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020015668
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015669ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
15670 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
15671 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015672
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015673
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200156747.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015675------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015676
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015677Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
15678sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
15679only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
15680For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
15681be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
15682can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
15683sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
15684for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
15685content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015686
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015687payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015688 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015689 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
15690 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015691
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015692payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
15693 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015694 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015695 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015696
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020015697req.hdrs : string
15698 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
15699 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
15700 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
15701 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
15702
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020015703req.hdrs_bin : binary
15704 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
15705 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
15706 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
15707 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
15708 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
15709 names and values (length of 0 for both).
15710
15711 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
15712
15713 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
15714 str: <int:length><bytes>
15715
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015716req.len : integer
15717req_len : integer (deprecated)
15718 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15719 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15720 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15721 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15722 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15723 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15724 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
15725 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015726
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015727req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15728 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015729 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15730 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15731 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15732 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015733
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015734 ACL alternatives :
15735 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015736
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015737req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15738 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15739 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15740 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
15741 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015742
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015743 ACL alternatives :
15744 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015745
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015746 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015747
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015748req.proto_http : boolean
15749req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
15750 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
15751 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
15752 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
15753 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
15754 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
15755 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
15756 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015757
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015758 Example:
15759 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
15760 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15761 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015762 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015763
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015764req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
15765rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15766 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
15767 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
15768 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
15769 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
15770 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
15771 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
15772 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015773
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015774 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
15775 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
15776 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
15777 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
15778 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
15779 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015780
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015781 ACL derivatives :
15782 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015783
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015784 Example :
15785 listen tse-farm
15786 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
15787 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
15788 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15789 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
15790 # apply RDP cookie persistence
15791 persist rdp-cookie
15792 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
15793 # This is only useful makes sense if
15794 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
15795 stick-table type string size 204800
15796 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
15797 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
15798 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015799
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015800 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
15801 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015802
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015803req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
15804rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
15805 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
15806 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
15807 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
15808 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015809
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015810 ACL derivatives :
15811 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015812
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015813req.ssl_alpn : string
15814 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
15815 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
15816 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
15817 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
15818 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
15819 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020015820 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015821
15822 Examples :
15823 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
15824 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15825 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020015826 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015827 default_backend bk_default
15828
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015829req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
15830 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
15831 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020015832 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
15833 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
15834 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
15835 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
15836 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015837
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015838req.ssl_hello_type : integer
15839req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15840 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15841 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
15842 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15843 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15844 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
15845 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15846 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015847
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015848req.ssl_sni : string
15849req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
15850 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
15851 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
15852 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
15853 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15854 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15855 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
15856 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
15857 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
15858 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
15859 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
15860 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
15861 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015862
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015863 ACL derivatives :
15864 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015865
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015866 Examples :
15867 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
15868 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15869 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
15870 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
15871 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015872
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053015873req.ssl_st_ext : integer
15874 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
15875 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
15876 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
15877 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
15878 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
15879 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
15880 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
15881 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
15882 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
15883
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015884req.ssl_ver : integer
15885req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
15886 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
15887 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
15888 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
15889 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
15890 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15891 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15892 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015893 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015894 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015895
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015896 ACL derivatives :
15897 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015898
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020015899res.len : integer
15900 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15901 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15902 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15903 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15904 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15905 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15906 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
15907 content inspection.
15908
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015909res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15910 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015911 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15912 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15913 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15914 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015915
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015916res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15917 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15918 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15919 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
15920 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015921
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015922 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015923
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020015924res.ssl_hello_type : integer
15925rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15926 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15927 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
15928 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15929 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15930 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
15931 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15932 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
15933
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015934wait_end : boolean
15935 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
15936 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015937 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015938 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
15939 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015940 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015941 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
15942 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015943
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015944 Examples :
15945 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
15946 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
15947 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015948
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015949 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
15950 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15951 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
15952 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
15953 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
15954 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
15955 tcp-request content reject
15956
15957
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200159587.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015959--------------------------------------
15960
15961It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
15962This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
15963data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
15964its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
15965HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
15966content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
15967to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
15968more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
15969response are indexed.
15970
15971base : string
15972 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
15973 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
15974 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
15975 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
15976 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
15977 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
15978 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
15979 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
15980
15981 ACL derivatives :
15982 base : exact string match
15983 base_beg : prefix match
15984 base_dir : subdir match
15985 base_dom : domain match
15986 base_end : suffix match
15987 base_len : length match
15988 base_reg : regex match
15989 base_sub : substring match
15990
15991base32 : integer
15992 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
15993 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
15994 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015995 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
15996 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
15997 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015998
15999base32+src : binary
16000 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
16001 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
16002 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
16003 per-URL counters.
16004
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010016005capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
16006 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
16007 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
16008 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
16009
16010capture.req.method : string
16011 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
16012 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
16013 because it's allocated.
16014
16015capture.req.uri : string
16016 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
16017 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
16018 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
16019 allocated.
16020
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020016021capture.req.ver : string
16022 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
16023 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
16024 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
16025
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010016026capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
16027 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
16028 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
16029 The first entry is an index of 0.
16030 See also: "capture response header"
16031
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020016032capture.res.ver : string
16033 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
16034 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
16035 persistent flag.
16036
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020016037req.body : binary
16038 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
16039 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
16040 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
16041 the first chunk is analyzed.
16042
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020016043req.body_param([<name>) : string
16044 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
16045 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
16046 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
16047 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
16048 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
16049 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
16050 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
16051 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
16052 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
16053 given.
16054
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020016055req.body_len : integer
16056 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
16057 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
16058 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
16059 "option http-buffer-request".
16060
16061req.body_size : integer
16062 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
16063 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
16064 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
16065 that the request body has been buffered made available using
16066 "option http-buffer-request".
16067
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016068req.cook([<name>]) : string
16069cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16070 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16071 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16072 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
16073 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
16074 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
16075 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
16076 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
16077 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
16078
16079 ACL derivatives :
16080 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
16081 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
16082 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
16083 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
16084 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
16085 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
16086 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
16087 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016088
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016089req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16090cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16091 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16092 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016093
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016094req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16095cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16096 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16097 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
16098 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
16099 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016100
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016101cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16102 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16103 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
16104 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
16105 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016106 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016107 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
16108 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
16109 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
16110 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016111
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016112hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16113 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
16114 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
16115 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
16116 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016117 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016118
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016119req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
16120 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
16121 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
16122 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16123 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16124 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16125 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
16126 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
16127 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016128
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016129req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16130 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
16131 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16132 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16133 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016134
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016135req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16136 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
16137 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
16138 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16139 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16140 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16141 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
16142 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
16143 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000016144 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016145 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016146 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016147
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016148 ACL derivatives :
16149 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16150 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16151 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16152 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16153 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16154 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16155 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16156 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16157
16158req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16159hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
16160 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
16161 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
16162 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
16163 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
16164 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
16165 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
16166 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
16167 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
16168 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
16169
16170req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16171hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16172 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
16173 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
16174 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
16175 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16176 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016177 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016178 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
16179 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
16180
16181req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16182hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16183 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
16184 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
16185 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
16186 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16187 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16188 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16189 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
16190
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010016191
16192
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016193http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
16194 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
16195 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
16196 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16197 basic auth is supported.
16198
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016199http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
16200 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
16201 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
16202 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
16203 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016204 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16205 basic auth is supported.
16206
16207 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016208 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
16209 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
16210 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
16211 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016212
16213http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016214 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
16215 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016216 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
16217 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016218
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016219method : integer + string
16220 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
16221 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
16222 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
16223 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
16224 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
16225 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
16226 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016227
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016228 ACL derivatives :
16229 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016230
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016231 Example :
16232 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
16233 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
16234 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016235
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016236path : string
16237 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
16238 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
16239 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
16240 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
16241 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016242 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016243 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016244
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016245 ACL derivatives :
16246 path : exact string match
16247 path_beg : prefix match
16248 path_dir : subdir match
16249 path_dom : domain match
16250 path_end : suffix match
16251 path_len : length match
16252 path_reg : regex match
16253 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016254
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016255query : string
16256 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
16257 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
16258 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
16259 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016260 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016261 which stops before the question mark.
16262
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016263req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16264 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16265 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16266 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16267 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16268
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016269req.ver : string
16270req_ver : string (deprecated)
16271 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
16272 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
16273 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016274
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016275 ACL derivatives :
16276 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016277
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016278res.comp : boolean
16279 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
16280 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
16281 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016282
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016283res.comp_algo : string
16284 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
16285 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
16286 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016287
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016288res.cook([<name>]) : string
16289scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16290 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16291 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16292 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016293
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016294 ACL derivatives :
16295 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016296
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016297res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16298scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16299 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16300 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
16301 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016302
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016303res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16304scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16305 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16306 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
16307 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016308
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016309res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16310 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16311 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16312 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16313 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16314 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
16315 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
16316 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
16317 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
16318 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016319
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016320res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16321 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16322 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16323 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16324 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
16325 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016326
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016327res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16328shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
16329 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16330 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16331 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16332 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16333 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
16334 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
16335 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
16336 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016337
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016338 ACL derivatives :
16339 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16340 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16341 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16342 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16343 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16344 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16345 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16346 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16347
16348res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16349shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16350 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16351 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16352 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
16353 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
16354 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016355
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016356res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16357shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16358 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
16359 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
16360 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
16361 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
16362 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
16363 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016364
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016365res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16366 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16367 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16368 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16369 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16370
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016371res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16372shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16373 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
16374 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16375 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
16376 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
16377 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
16378 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016379
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016380res.ver : string
16381resp_ver : string (deprecated)
16382 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
16383 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016384
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016385 ACL derivatives :
16386 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016387
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016388set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16389 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16390 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016391 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016392 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016393
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016394 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
16395 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016396
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016397status : integer
16398 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
16399 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
16400 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016401
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020016402unique-id : string
16403 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
16404 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
16405 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
16406 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
16407 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
16408 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
16409
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016410url : string
16411 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
16412 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
16413 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
16414 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
16415 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
16416 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
16417 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016418
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016419 ACL derivatives :
16420 url : exact string match
16421 url_beg : prefix match
16422 url_dir : subdir match
16423 url_dom : domain match
16424 url_end : suffix match
16425 url_len : length match
16426 url_reg : regex match
16427 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016428
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016429url_ip : ip
16430 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
16431 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
16432 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
16433 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
16434 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
16435 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16436 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016437
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016438url_port : integer
16439 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
16440 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
16441 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16442 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016443
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016444urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
16445url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016446 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
16447 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016448 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
16449 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
16450 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
16451 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016452 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
16453 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016454 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
16455 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016456
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016457 ACL derivatives :
16458 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
16459 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
16460 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
16461 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
16462 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
16463 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
16464 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
16465 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016466
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016467
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016468 Example :
16469 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
16470 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
16471 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
16472 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016473
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016474urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016475 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
16476 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
16477 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020016478
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020016479url32 : integer
16480 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
16481 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
16482 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
16483 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
16484 is an unsigned integer.
16485
16486url32+src : binary
16487 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
16488 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
16489 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
16490
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010016491
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200164927.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016493---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016494
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016495Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
16496every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020016497order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016498
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016499ACL name Equivalent to Usage
16500---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016501FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020016502HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016503HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
16504HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016505HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
16506HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
16507HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
16508HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
16509LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016510METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016511METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016512METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
16513METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
16514METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
16515METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016516METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016517METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020016518RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016519REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016520TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016521WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
16522---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016523
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010016524
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165258. Logging
16526----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010016527
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016528One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
16529provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
16530very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
16531provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
16532state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016533to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016534headers.
16535
16536In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
16537about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
16538send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
16539
16540 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
16541 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
16542 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
16543 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
16544 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016545 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060016546 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016547
16548The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
16549allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
16550as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
16551while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
16552real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
16553delay.
16554
16555
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165568.1. Log levels
16557---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016558
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016559TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016560source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016561HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
16562in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
16563track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
16564syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
16565about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016566
16567
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165688.2. Log formats
16569----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016570
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016571HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016572and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
16573slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
16574options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016575
16576 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
16577 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
16578 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
16579 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
16580 extents.
16581
16582 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
16583 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
16584 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
16585 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
16586 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
16587
16588 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
16589 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
16590 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
16591 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
16592 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
16593
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020016594 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
16595 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
16596 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
16597 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
16598
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016599 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
16600
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016601Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
16602specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
16603field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
16604servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
16605always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
16606identifier.
16607
16608Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
16609 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
16610 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
16611 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
16612 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
16613
16614
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200166158.2.1. Default log format
16616-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016617
16618This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
16619as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
16620format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
16621
16622 Example :
16623 listen www
16624 mode http
16625 log global
16626 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16627
16628 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
16629 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
16630 (www/HTTP)
16631
16632 Field Format Extract from the example above
16633 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
16634 2 'Connect from' Connect from
16635 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
16636 4 'to' to
16637 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
16638 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
16639
16640Detailed fields description :
16641 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
16642 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
16643 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
16644 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
16645 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16646 and processed the connection.
16647 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
16648
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016649In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
16650"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
16651connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
16652
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016653It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
16654will eventually disappear.
16655
16656
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200166578.2.2. TCP log format
16658---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016659
16660The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
16661is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
16662information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
16663counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
16664emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
16665environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
16666the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
16667sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016668specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
16669not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
16670fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
16671marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016672
16673 Example :
16674 frontend fnt
16675 mode tcp
16676 option tcplog
16677 log global
16678 default_backend bck
16679
16680 backend bck
16681 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16682
16683 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
16684 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
16685 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
16686
16687 Field Format Extract from the example above
16688 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
16689 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
16690 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
16691 4 frontend_name fnt
16692 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
16693 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
16694 7 bytes_read* 212
16695 8 termination_state --
16696 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
16697 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16698
16699Detailed fields description :
16700 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016701 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16702 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16703 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016704 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016705 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016706 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016707
16708 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016709 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
16710 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
16711 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016712
16713 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
16714 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
16715 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016716 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
16717 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
16718 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
16719 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016720
16721 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16722 and processed the connection.
16723
16724 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
16725 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
16726 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
16727 applications.
16728
16729 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16730 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16731 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16732 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
16733 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
16734
16735 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
16736 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
16737 See "Timers" below for more details.
16738
16739 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
16740 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
16741 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
16742 "Timers" below for more details.
16743
16744 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016745 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016746 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
16747 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
16748 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
16749 details.
16750
16751 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
16752 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
16753 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
16754 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
16755 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
16756
16757 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
16758 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
16759 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
16760 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
16761 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
16762 for more details.
16763
16764 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016765 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016766 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
16767 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
16768 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016769 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016770
16771 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
16772 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
16773 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
16774 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
16775 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
16776 caused by a denial of service attack.
16777
16778 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
16779 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
16780 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
16781 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
16782 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
16783 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
16784 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
16785 denial of service attack.
16786
16787 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
16788 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
16789 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
16790 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
16791 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
16792 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
16793 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
16794 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
16795 be processed than on other servers.
16796
16797 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
16798 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
16799 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
16800 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
16801 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
16802 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
16803 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
16804 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
16805 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
16806 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
16807 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
16808 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
16809 should not be attributed to the logged server.
16810
16811 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16812 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
16813 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
16814 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
16815 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
16816 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016817 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016818 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
16819
16820 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16821 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
16822 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
16823 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
16824 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
16825 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016826 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016827 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
16828 occurs.
16829
16830
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200168318.2.3. HTTP log format
16832----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016833
16834The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
16835is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
16836the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
16837are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
16838emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
16839generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
16840"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
16841which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016842frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
16843is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016844
16845Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
16846slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
16847with a star ('*') after the field name below.
16848
16849 Example :
16850 frontend http-in
16851 mode http
16852 option httplog
16853 log global
16854 default_backend bck
16855
16856 backend static
16857 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16858
16859 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
16860 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
16861 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016862 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016863
16864 Field Format Extract from the example above
16865 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
16866 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016867 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016868 4 frontend_name http-in
16869 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016870 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016871 7 status_code 200
16872 8 bytes_read* 2750
16873 9 captured_request_cookie -
16874 10 captured_response_cookie -
16875 11 termination_state ----
16876 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
16877 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16878 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
16879 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
16880 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016881
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016882Detailed fields description :
16883 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016884 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16885 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16886 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016887 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016888 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016889 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016890
16891 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016892 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
16893 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
16894 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016895
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016896 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
16897 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016898
16899 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16900 and processed the connection.
16901
16902 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
16903 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
16904 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
16905
16906 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16907 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16908 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16909 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
16910 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
16911 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
16912
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016913 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
16914 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
16915 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
16916 request could be received or the a bad request was received. It should
16917 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
16918 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016919 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
16920 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016921
16922 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
16923 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016924 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016925
16926 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
16927 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016928 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
16929 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016930
16931 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
16932 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
16933 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
16934 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
16935 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016936 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
16937 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016938
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016939 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
16940 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
16941 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
16942 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
16943 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
16944 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
16945 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016946 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016947
16948 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
16949 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
16950 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
16951
16952 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
16953 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
16954 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
16955 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
16956 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
16957 overflowing.
16958
16959 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
16960 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
16961 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
16962 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
16963 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
16964 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
16965 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
16966 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
16967
16968 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
16969 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
16970 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
16971 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
16972 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
16973 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
16974 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
16975 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
16976
16977 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
16978 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
16979 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
16980 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
16981 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
16982 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
16983 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
16984
16985 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016986 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016987 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
16988 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
16989 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016990 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016991 system.
16992
16993 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
16994 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
16995 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
16996 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
16997 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
16998 caused by a denial of service attack.
16999
17000 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
17001 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
17002 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
17003 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
17004 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
17005 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
17006 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
17007 denial of service attack.
17008
17009 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
17010 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
17011 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
17012 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
17013 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
17014 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
17015 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
17016 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
17017 processed than on other servers.
17018
17019 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
17020 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
17021 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
17022 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
17023 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
17024 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
17025 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
17026 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
17027 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
17028 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
17029 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
17030 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
17031 should not be attributed to the logged server.
17032
17033 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17034 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
17035 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
17036 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
17037 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
17038 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017039 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017040 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
17041
17042 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17043 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
17044 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
17045 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
17046 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
17047 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017048 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017049 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
17050 occurs.
17051
17052 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
17053 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
17054 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
17055 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
17056 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
17057 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
17058 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
17059 cookies" below for more details.
17060
17061 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
17062 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
17063 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
17064 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
17065 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
17066 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
17067 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
17068 and cookies" below for more details.
17069
17070 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
17071 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
17072 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
17073 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
17074 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
17075 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
17076 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
17077 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
17078
17079
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200170808.2.4. Custom log format
17081------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017082
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017083The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017084mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017085
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017086HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017087Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
17088separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
17089prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
17090
17091Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
17092variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017093("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017094
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010017095If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020017096as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010017097less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
17098the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
17099
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017100Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017101In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010017102in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017103
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017104Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
17105'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
17106https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
17107such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
17108
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017109Flags are :
17110 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017111 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017112 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
17113 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017114
17115 Example:
17116
17117 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
17118 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
17119
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017120 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
17121
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017122At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
17123
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017124 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
17125 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017126
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017127the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017128
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017129 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
17130 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
17131 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017132
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017133and the default TCP format is defined this way :
17134
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017135 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
17136 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017137
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017138Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
17139
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017140 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017141 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017142 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
17143 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
17144 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017145 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
17146 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
17147 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017148 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017149 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
17150 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000017151 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017152 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
17153 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010017154 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020017155 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017156 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017157 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017158 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020017159 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080017160 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017161 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
17162 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
17163 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
17164 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
17165 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017166 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017167 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
17168 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017169 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017170 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
17171 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017172 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17173 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
17174 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017175 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017176 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
17177 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017178 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017179 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17180 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
17181 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020017182 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020017183 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020017184 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
17185 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
17186 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
17187 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020017188 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017189 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017190 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017191 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010017192 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017193 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017194 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
17195 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
17196 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017197 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017198 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
17199 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017200 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017201 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
17202 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020017203 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017204 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017205 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017206 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017207
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017208 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017209
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017210
172118.2.5. Error log format
17212-----------------------
17213
17214When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
17215protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
17216By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
17217"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017218will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017219logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
17220
17221The format looks like this :
17222
17223 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
17224 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
17225 Connection error during SSL handshake
17226
17227 Field Format Extract from the example above
17228 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
17229 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
17230 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
17231 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
17232 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
17233
17234These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
17235failures.
17236
17237
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172388.3. Advanced logging options
17239-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017240
17241Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
17242just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
17243options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
17244for more information about their usage.
17245
17246
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172478.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
17248------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017249
17250It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
17251haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
17252commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
17253monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
17254ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
17255
17256 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
17257 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
17258 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
17259 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
17260
17261 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
17262 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
17263 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017264 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017265 such as other load-balancers.
17266
17267 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
17268 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
17269 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
17270
17271
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172728.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
17273----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017274
17275The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
17276what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
17277or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017278"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017279just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
17280log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
17281after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
17282is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
17283with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
17284with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
17285
17286
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172878.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
17288------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017289
17290Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
17291for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
17292"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
17293retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
17294raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
17295a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
17296file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
17297you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
17298"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
17299
17300
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173018.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
17302--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017303
17304Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
17305multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
17306them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
17307"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
17308logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
17309error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
17310and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
17311too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
17312useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
17313alternative.
17314
17315
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173168.4. Timing events
17317------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017318
17319Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
17320reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
17321the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
17322frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017323mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
17324addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
17325
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010017326Timings events in HTTP mode:
17327
17328 first request 2nd request
17329 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
17330 t tr t tr ...
17331 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
17332 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
17333 :<---- Tq ---->: :
17334 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
17335 :<--------- Ta --------->:
17336
17337Timings events in TCP mode:
17338
17339 TCP session
17340 |<----------------->|
17341 t t
17342 ---|----|----|----|----|---
17343 | Th Tw Tc Td |
17344 |<------ Tt ------->|
17345
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017346 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017347 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017348 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
17349 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
17350 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017351 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017352 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
17353 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
17354 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
17355 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017356
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017357 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
17358 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
17359 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017360 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
17361 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
17362 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
17363 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
17364 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
17365 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017366
17367 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
17368 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
17369 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
17370 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
17371 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
17372 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
17373 request typed by hand during a test.
17374
17375 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
17376 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017377 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017378 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
17379 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
17380 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
17381 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017382
17383 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
17384 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
17385 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
17386 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
17387 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
17388
17389 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
17390 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
17391 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
17392 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
17393 connection never established.
17394
17395 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
17396 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
17397 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
17398 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
17399 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
17400 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
17401 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
17402 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
17403 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
17404 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
17405 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
17406
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017407 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
17408 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
17409 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
17410 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
17411 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
17412 by subtracting other timers when valid :
17413
17414 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
17415
17416 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
17417 "Ta" can never be negative.
17418
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017419 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
17420 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017421 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
17422 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017423 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017424
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017425 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017426
17427 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017428 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
17429 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017430
17431These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
17432protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
17433that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017434due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
17435"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
17436that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017437
17438Most common cases :
17439
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017440 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
17441 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
17442 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
17443 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
17444 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
17445 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
17446 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
17447 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
17448 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
17449 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
17450 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020017451 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017452
17453 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
17454 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
17455 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
17456 of ms on remote networks.
17457
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017458 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
17459 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
17460 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017461
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017462 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
17463 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
17464 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
17465 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
17466 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
17467 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
17468 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
17469 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
17470 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017471
17472Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
17473
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017474 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017475 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017476 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017477
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017478 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017479 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
17480 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
17481
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017482 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017483 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
17484 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
17485 flags.
17486
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017487 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
17488 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017489 Check the session termination flags, then check the
17490 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
17491 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
17492 the client connection was maintained open.
17493
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017494 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017495 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017496 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017497 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
17498
17499
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200175008.5. Session state at disconnection
17501-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017502
17503TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
17504"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
175052-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
17506each of which has a special meaning :
17507
17508 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
17509 session to terminate :
17510
17511 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
17512
17513 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
17514 server explicitly refused it.
17515
17516 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
17517 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
17518 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
17519 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017520 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017521
17522 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
17523 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017524
17525 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
17526 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
17527 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
17528 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
17529 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
17530
17531 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
17532 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
17533 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
17534 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
17535 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
17536
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090017537 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
17538 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
17539
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070017540 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
17541 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
17542 backup connections when going up.
17543
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020017544 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
17545
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017546 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
17547 send or receive data.
17548
17549 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
17550 send or receive data.
17551
17552 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
17553 with nothing left in the buffers.
17554
17555 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
17556
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010017557 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017558 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
17559
17560 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
17561 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
17562 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
17563 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
17564 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
17565
17566 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
17567 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
17568
17569 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
17570 server (HTTP only).
17571
17572 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
17573
17574 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
17575 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
17576 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
17577
17578 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
17579 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
17580 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
17581
17582 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
17583
17584 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
17585 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
17586
17587 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
17588 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
17589 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
17590
17591 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
17592 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020017593 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
17594 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017595
17596 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
17597 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
17598 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
17599 another server.
17600
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017601 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017602 server.
17603
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017604 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
17605 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
17606 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
17607 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17608
17609 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
17610 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
17611 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
17612 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17613
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020017614 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
17615 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
17616 "use-server" rule).
17617
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017618 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17619
17620 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
17621 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
17622
17623 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
17624
17625 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
17626 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
17627 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
17628
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017629 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
17630 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017631 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017632 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
17633 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
17634
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017635 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
17636
17637 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
17638 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
17639
17640 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
17641
17642 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17643
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017644The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
17645was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017646helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
17647starvation, attacks, etc...
17648
17649The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
17650alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
17651easier finding and understanding.
17652
17653 Flags Reason
17654
17655 -- Normal termination.
17656
17657 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
17658 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
17659 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
17660 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
17661
17662 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
17663 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
17664 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
17665 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
17666 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
17667 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017668
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017669 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17670 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017671 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017672
17673 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
17674 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
17675 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
17676
17677 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
17678 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
17679 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
17680 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
17681 the server takes too long to respond.
17682
17683 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
17684 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
17685 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
17686 long a time to respond.
17687
17688 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
17689 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
17690 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
17691 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017692 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
17693 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017694
17695 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
17696 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
17697 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
17698 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
17699 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020017700 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017701 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
17702 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
17703 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
17704 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
17705 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
17706 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
17707 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
17708 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017709 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017710 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
17711 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
17712 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017713
17714 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
17715 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017716 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
17717 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
17718 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
17719 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017720
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017721 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
17722 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
17723
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017724 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017725 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
17726 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017727 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017728 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
17729 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
17730
17731 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
17732 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
17733 503 or 504 here.
17734
17735 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
17736 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
17737 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
17738 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
17739 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
17740
17741 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17742 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017743 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017744 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
17745 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
17746
17747 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
17748 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
17749 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
17750 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
17751 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
17752 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
17753 between haproxy and the server.
17754
17755 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
17756 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
17757 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
17758 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
17759 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
17760 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
17761 solution is to fix the application.
17762
17763 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
17764 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
17765 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
17766 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
17767 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
17768 external attacks.
17769
17770 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
17771 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017772 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017773 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
17774 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
17775
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017776 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
17777 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
17778 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017779 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020017780 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017781
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017782 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
17783 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
17784 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
17785 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017786 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
17787 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
17788 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
17789 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
17790 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017791
17792 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
17793 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
17794 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
17795 returned an HTTP 403 error.
17796
17797 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
17798 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
17799 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
17800 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
17801
17802 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
17803 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
17804 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
17805 only be solved by proper system tuning.
17806
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017807The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
17808persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
17809important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
17810re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
17811
17812 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
17813
17814 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17815 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
17816 set on a GET request.
17817
17818 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
17819 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017820 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017821 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
17822
17823 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
17824 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
17825 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
17826
17827 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17828 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
17829 already got a cookie.
17830
17831 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17832 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
17833 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
17834 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
17835 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
17836
17837 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17838 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
17839 new cookie was inserted in the response.
17840
17841 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
17842 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
17843 new cookie was inserted in the response.
17844
17845 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
17846 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
17847
17848 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
17849 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
17850 then advertised in the response.
17851
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017852
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178538.6. Non-printable characters
17854-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017855
17856In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
17857consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
17858converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
17859prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
17860being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
17861escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
17862is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
17863'}' when logging headers.
17864
17865Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
17866issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
17867containing spaces is "User-Agent".
17868
17869Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
17870the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
17871performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
17872
17873
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178748.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
17875---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017876
17877Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
17878achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017879section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017880cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
17881the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
17882the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017883locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017884not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
17885user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
17886a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
17887wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
17888
17889 Examples :
17890 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
17891 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
17892
17893 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
17894 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
17895
17896
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178978.8. Capturing HTTP headers
17898---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017899
17900Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
17901proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
17902the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
17903server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
17904
17905Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
17906response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017907section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017908
17909It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017910time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
17911appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017912are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
17913and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
17914follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
17915request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
17916in the logs.
17917
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020017918As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
17919frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
17920an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
17921
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017922 Example :
17923 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
17924 listen proxy-out
17925 mode http
17926 option httplog
17927 option logasap
17928 log global
17929 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
17930
17931 # log the name of the virtual server
17932 capture request header Host len 20
17933
17934 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
17935 capture request header Content-Length len 10
17936
17937 # log the beginning of the referrer
17938 capture request header Referer len 20
17939
17940 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
17941 capture response header Server len 20
17942
17943 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
17944 capture response header Content-Length len 10
17945
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017946 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017947 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
17948
17949 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
17950 capture response header Via len 20
17951
17952 # log the URL location during a redirection
17953 capture response header Location len 20
17954
17955 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
17956 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
17957 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17958 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
17959 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
17960
17961 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
17962 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
17963 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17964 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017965 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017966
17967 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
17968 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
17969 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17970 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
17971 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017972 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017973
17974
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179758.9. Examples of logs
17976---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017977
17978These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
17979them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
17980reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
17981
17982 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
17983 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
17984 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
17985
17986 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
17987 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
17988
17989 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
17990 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
17991 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
17992
17993 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
17994 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
17995
17996 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
17997 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
17998 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
17999
18000 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018001 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018002 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
18003 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
18004
18005 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
18006 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
18007 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
18008
18009 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
18010 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020018011 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018012 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
18013 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
18014 to return the 502 and not the server.
18015
18016 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018017 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018018
18019 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
18020 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
18021 Nothing was sent to any server.
18022
18023 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
18024 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
18025
18026 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
18027 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018028 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018029 send a 408 return code to the client.
18030
18031 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
18032 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
18033
18034 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
18035 5 seconds ("c----").
18036
18037 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
18038 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018039 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018040
18041 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018042 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018043 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
18044 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
18045 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
18046 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
18047 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010018048
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020018049
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200180509. Supported filters
18051--------------------
18052
18053Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
18054accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
18055unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
18056
18057See also : "filter"
18058
180599.1. Trace
18060----------
18061
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010018062filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018063
18064 Arguments:
18065 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
18066 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
18067
18068 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
18069 the client and the server. By default, this filter
18070 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
18071 only parses a random amount of the available data.
18072
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018073 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018074 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
18075 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
18076 amount of the parsed data.
18077
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018078 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010018079
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018080This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
18081callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
18082information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
18083filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
18084
18085Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
18086tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
18087a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
18088
18089
180909.2. HTTP compression
18091---------------------
18092
18093filter compression
18094
18095The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
18096keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018097when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache enabled,
18098it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always done after the
18099response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter
18100line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one filter other than the
18101cache is used for the same listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know
18102the filters evaluation order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018103
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018104See also : "compression" and section 9.4 about the cache filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018105
18106
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200181079.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
18108--------------------------------------------
18109
18110filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
18111
18112 Arguments :
18113
18114 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
18115 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
18116 parsed.
18117
18118 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
18119 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
18120 part must be placed in its own scope.
18121
18122The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
18123external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018124streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020018125exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
18126also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
18127
18128SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
18129the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
18130
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010018131For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020018132"doc/SPOE.txt".
18133
18134Important note:
18135 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
18136 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
18137
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100181389.4. Cache
18139----------
18140
18141filter cache <name>
18142
18143 Arguments :
18144
18145 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
18146
18147The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
18148"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
18149cache. By default the correpsonding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018150other filters than cache or compression are used, it is enough. In such case,
18151the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it is
18152mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
18153filter other than the compression is used for the same
18154listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
18155order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018156
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018157See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter and section 10 about cache.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018158
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01001815910. Cache
18160---------
18161
18162HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
18163(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
18164RAM.
18165
18166The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010018167this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018168
18169If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
18170independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
18171when we try to allocate a new one.
18172
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010018173The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018174
18175It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
18176"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
18177for more details.
18178
18179When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
18180replaced by "<CACHE>".
18181
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001818210.1. Limitation
18183----------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018184
18185The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
18186
18187- If the response is not a 200
18188- If the response contains a Vary header
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018189- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018190- If the response is not cacheable
18191
18192- If the request is not a GET
18193- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
William Lallemand8a16fe02018-05-22 11:04:33 +020018194- If the request contains an Authorization header
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018195
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018196Caution!: For HAProxy version prior to 1.9, due to the limitation of the
18197filters, it is not recommended to use the cache with other filters. Using them
18198can cause undefined behavior if they modify the response (compression for
18199example). For HAProxy 1.9 and greater, it is safe, for HTX proxies only (see
18200"option http-use-htx" for details).
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018201
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001820210.2. Setup
18203-----------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018204
18205To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
18206the corresponding http-request and response actions.
18207
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001820810.2.1. Cache section
18209---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018210
18211cache <name>
18212 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
18213 size of cache is mandatory.
18214
18215total-max-size <megabytes>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018216 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
Frédéric Lécaillee3c83d82018-10-25 10:46:40 +020018217 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018218
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018219max-object-size <bytes>
Frédéric Lécaillee3c83d82018-10-25 10:46:40 +020018220 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
18221 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
18222 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018223
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018224max-age <seconds>
18225 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
18226 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
18227 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
18228 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
18229 default.
18230
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001823110.2.2. Proxy section
18232---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018233
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +020018234http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018235 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
18236 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
18237 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
18238 after this one.
18239
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +020018240http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018241 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
18242 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
18243 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
18244 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
18245
18246
18247Example:
18248
18249 backend bck1
18250 mode http
18251
18252 http-request cache-use foobar
18253 http-response cache-store foobar
18254 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
18255
18256 cache foobar
18257 total-max-size 4
18258 max-age 240
18259
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018260/*
18261 * Local variables:
18262 * fill-column: 79
18263 * End:
18264 */